WO2011113020A1 - Measurement devices and methods for measuring analyte concentration incorporating temperature and ph correction - Google Patents

Measurement devices and methods for measuring analyte concentration incorporating temperature and ph correction Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2011113020A1
WO2011113020A1 PCT/US2011/028222 US2011028222W WO2011113020A1 WO 2011113020 A1 WO2011113020 A1 WO 2011113020A1 US 2011028222 W US2011028222 W US 2011028222W WO 2011113020 A1 WO2011113020 A1 WO 2011113020A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
temperature
michaelis
menten
analyte
equation
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US2011/028222
Other languages
French (fr)
Inventor
Matthew A. Romey
Soya Gamsey
Thomas A. Peyser
Original Assignee
Glumetrics, Inc.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Glumetrics, Inc. filed Critical Glumetrics, Inc.
Priority to EP11754226.6A priority Critical patent/EP2545373B1/en
Publication of WO2011113020A1 publication Critical patent/WO2011113020A1/en

Links

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61BDIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
    • A61B5/00Measuring for diagnostic purposes; Identification of persons
    • A61B5/145Measuring characteristics of blood in vivo, e.g. gas concentration, pH value; Measuring characteristics of body fluids or tissues, e.g. interstitial fluid, cerebral tissue
    • A61B5/14532Measuring characteristics of blood in vivo, e.g. gas concentration, pH value; Measuring characteristics of body fluids or tissues, e.g. interstitial fluid, cerebral tissue for measuring glucose, e.g. by tissue impedance measurement
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F17/00Digital computing or data processing equipment or methods, specially adapted for specific functions
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61BDIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
    • A61B5/00Measuring for diagnostic purposes; Identification of persons
    • A61B5/145Measuring characteristics of blood in vivo, e.g. gas concentration, pH value; Measuring characteristics of body fluids or tissues, e.g. interstitial fluid, cerebral tissue
    • A61B5/1455Measuring characteristics of blood in vivo, e.g. gas concentration, pH value; Measuring characteristics of body fluids or tissues, e.g. interstitial fluid, cerebral tissue using optical sensors, e.g. spectral photometrical oximeters
    • A61B5/1459Measuring characteristics of blood in vivo, e.g. gas concentration, pH value; Measuring characteristics of body fluids or tissues, e.g. interstitial fluid, cerebral tissue using optical sensors, e.g. spectral photometrical oximeters invasive, e.g. introduced into the body by a catheter
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61BDIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
    • A61B5/00Measuring for diagnostic purposes; Identification of persons
    • A61B5/145Measuring characteristics of blood in vivo, e.g. gas concentration, pH value; Measuring characteristics of body fluids or tissues, e.g. interstitial fluid, cerebral tissue
    • A61B5/1495Calibrating or testing of in-vivo probes
    • GPHYSICS
    • G01MEASURING; TESTING
    • G01NINVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
    • G01N21/00Investigating or analysing materials by the use of optical means, i.e. using sub-millimetre waves, infrared, visible or ultraviolet light
    • G01N21/62Systems in which the material investigated is excited whereby it emits light or causes a change in wavelength of the incident light
    • G01N21/63Systems in which the material investigated is excited whereby it emits light or causes a change in wavelength of the incident light optically excited
    • G01N21/64Fluorescence; Phosphorescence
    • G01N21/6428Measuring fluorescence of fluorescent products of reactions or of fluorochrome labelled reactive substances, e.g. measuring quenching effects, using measuring "optrodes"
    • GPHYSICS
    • G01MEASURING; TESTING
    • G01NINVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
    • G01N21/00Investigating or analysing materials by the use of optical means, i.e. using sub-millimetre waves, infrared, visible or ultraviolet light
    • G01N21/75Systems in which material is subjected to a chemical reaction, the progress or the result of the reaction being investigated
    • G01N21/77Systems in which material is subjected to a chemical reaction, the progress or the result of the reaction being investigated by observing the effect on a chemical indicator
    • G01N21/7703Systems in which material is subjected to a chemical reaction, the progress or the result of the reaction being investigated by observing the effect on a chemical indicator using reagent-clad optical fibres or optical waveguides
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61BDIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
    • A61B2560/00Constructional details of operational features of apparatus; Accessories for medical measuring apparatus
    • A61B2560/02Operational features
    • A61B2560/0242Operational features adapted to measure environmental factors, e.g. temperature, pollution
    • A61B2560/0247Operational features adapted to measure environmental factors, e.g. temperature, pollution for compensation or correction of the measured physiological value
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61BDIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
    • A61B2560/00Constructional details of operational features of apparatus; Accessories for medical measuring apparatus
    • A61B2560/02Operational features
    • A61B2560/0242Operational features adapted to measure environmental factors, e.g. temperature, pollution
    • A61B2560/0247Operational features adapted to measure environmental factors, e.g. temperature, pollution for compensation or correction of the measured physiological value
    • A61B2560/0252Operational features adapted to measure environmental factors, e.g. temperature, pollution for compensation or correction of the measured physiological value using ambient temperature
    • GPHYSICS
    • G01MEASURING; TESTING
    • G01NINVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
    • G01N21/00Investigating or analysing materials by the use of optical means, i.e. using sub-millimetre waves, infrared, visible or ultraviolet light
    • G01N21/62Systems in which the material investigated is excited whereby it emits light or causes a change in wavelength of the incident light
    • G01N21/63Systems in which the material investigated is excited whereby it emits light or causes a change in wavelength of the incident light optically excited
    • G01N21/64Fluorescence; Phosphorescence
    • G01N2021/6417Spectrofluorimetric devices
    • G01N2021/6419Excitation at two or more wavelengths
    • GPHYSICS
    • G01MEASURING; TESTING
    • G01NINVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
    • G01N21/00Investigating or analysing materials by the use of optical means, i.e. using sub-millimetre waves, infrared, visible or ultraviolet light
    • G01N21/62Systems in which the material investigated is excited whereby it emits light or causes a change in wavelength of the incident light
    • G01N21/63Systems in which the material investigated is excited whereby it emits light or causes a change in wavelength of the incident light optically excited
    • G01N21/64Fluorescence; Phosphorescence
    • G01N21/645Specially adapted constructive features of fluorimeters
    • G01N2021/6484Optical fibres
    • GPHYSICS
    • G01MEASURING; TESTING
    • G01NINVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
    • G01N21/00Investigating or analysing materials by the use of optical means, i.e. using sub-millimetre waves, infrared, visible or ultraviolet light
    • G01N21/75Systems in which material is subjected to a chemical reaction, the progress or the result of the reaction being investigated
    • G01N21/77Systems in which material is subjected to a chemical reaction, the progress or the result of the reaction being investigated by observing the effect on a chemical indicator
    • G01N2021/7793Sensor comprising plural indicators

Definitions

  • the present application discloses embodiments which relate to the field of analyte concentration measurement, more specifically, glucose concentration measurement, and, in some embodiments, algorithms and methods of temperature and/or pH correction, and measurement devices which perform temperature and/or pH correction.
  • Types 1 and 2 diabetes are endocrine disorders characterized by abnormalities in the body's ability to regulate glucose metabolism. While the underlying pathology of these two illnesses differ, both are associated with significant complications including diabetic nephropathy, neuropathy, retinopathy, problems with wound healing, as well as an elevated risk of cerebrovascular and cardiovascular disease. While the mechanism of action is uncertain, it is believed that elevated glucose levels are associated with the release of various inflammatory mediators that produce vascular damage ultimately leading to these complications. Abnormally low glucose levels can also be problematic resulting in anxiety, weakness, and in extreme cases coma and death. researchers and clinicians have increasingly become aware of the importance of maintaining tight control of glucose levels, particularly in acute care settings, so as to prevent these complications from occurring and to facilitate patient recovery.
  • a more accurate determination of the patient's glucose level can be obtained by measuring plasma glucose. This requires the separation of the plasma from the other components of the blood such as red and white blood cells.
  • analytical methods for measuring plasma glucose concentration include the measurement of the current produced by glucose oxidation, the use of the hexokinase reaction, or through the use of mass spectrometry. While the latter represents the "gold standard" for glucose measurement, these methods can be technically complicated, time-consuming, and are frequently not cost- effective for clinical use. For example, for the most accurate readings, lipids should be removed from the plasma and the results should be adjusted for the sodium content, but both are rarely done.
  • results can vary depending on how much protein-bound and intercellular glucose has been released into the sample prior to and during processing. While plasma glucose measurements can provide relatively accurate information, transportation and processing times can lead to a significant delay between when the sample is collected and when the results are available to the clinician. Therefore, it is not feasible to use plasma glucose measurements for near-instantaneous, or "real-time" monitoring of a patient's glucose level.
  • analyte concentration may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a temperature, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data which may include temperature calibration data and the signal indicative of a temperature.
  • Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a temperature, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more temperature calibration parameters and the signal indicative of temperature.
  • Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a pH, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data which may include pH calibration data, and the signal indicative of a pH.
  • Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a pH, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more pH calibration parameters and the signal indicative of pH.
  • Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a temperature, generating a signal indicative of a pH, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data which may include temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of a temperature, and the signal indicative of a pH.
  • Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration of a solution which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the solution, generating a signal indicative of a temperature of the solution, generating a signal indicative of a pH of the solution, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of the temperature, and the signal indicative of the pH.
  • the measurement devices may include an analyte sensing element, a temperature sensing element, and a receiving and processing unit.
  • the analyte sensing element may be configured to generate a first signal, the first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample.
  • the temperature sensing element may be configured to generate a second signal, the second signal indicative of a temperature of the sample.
  • the receiving and processing unit may be configured to transform the first signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data which may include temperature calibration data, and the second signal.
  • the measurement devices for estimating an analyte concentration of a sample may, in some embodiments, include an analyte sensing element, a pH sensing element, and a receiving and processing unit.
  • the analyte sensing element may be configured to generate a first signal, the first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample.
  • the pH sensing element may be configured to generate a second signal, the second signal indicative of a pH of the sample.
  • the receiving and processing unit may be configured to transform the first signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending upon Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data which may include pH calibration data, and the second signal.
  • the measurement devices for estimating an analyte concentration of a sample may, in some embodiments, include an analyte sensing element, a temperature sensing element, and a pH sensing element.
  • the analyte sensing element may be configured to generate a first signal, the first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample.
  • the temperature sensing element may be configured to generate a second signal, the second signal indicative of a temperature of the sample.
  • the pH sensing element may be configured to generate a third signal, the third signal indicative of a pH of the sample.
  • the receiving and processing unit may be configured to transform the first signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data which may include temperature and pH calibration data, the second signal, and the third signal.
  • the measurement devices for estimating an analyte concentration of a sample may, in some embodiments, include an analyte and pH sensing element, and a receiving and processing unit.
  • the analyte and pH sensing element may be configured to generate a first signal, the first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and a pH of the sample.
  • the analyte and pH sensing element may be configured to generate a second signal, the second signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and the pH of the sample.
  • the receiving and processing unit may be configured to transform a third signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data which may include pH calibration data and a fourth signal.
  • the third signal may be indicative of the analyte concentration and may be generated based upon data which may include the first signal and the second signal.
  • the fourth signal may be indicative of the pH and may be generated based upon data which may include the first signal and the second signal.
  • the measurement devices for estimating an analyte concentration of a sample may, in some embodiments, include an analyte and pH sensing element, a temperature sensing element, and a receiving and processing unit.
  • the analyte and pH sensing element may be configured to generate a first signal, the first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and a pH of the sample, and a second signal, the second signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and the pH of the sample.
  • the temperature sensing element may be configured to generate a third signal, the third signal indicative of a temperature of the sample.
  • the receiving and processing unit may be configured to transform a fourth signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data which may include temperature and pH calibration data, the third signal, and a fifth signal.
  • the fourth signal may be indicative of the analyte concentration and may be generated based upon data which may include the first signal and the second signal.
  • the fifth signal may be indicative of the pH and may be generated based upon data which may include the first signal and the second signal.
  • the methods may include transforming the signal using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein the values of one or more Michaelis-Menten parameters have been adjusted for temperature.
  • the values of one or more Michaelis-Menten parameters may also have been adjusted for pH.
  • Figure 1A is a flow chart schematically illustrating the sensing mechanism of one embodiment of the present invention which includes a temperature sensing element and an analyte sensing element.
  • Figure IB is a flow chart schematically illustrating the sensing mechanism of one embodiment of the present invention which includes an analyte sensing element and a pH sensing element.
  • Figure 1C is a flow chart schematically illustrating the sensing mechanism of one embodiment of the present invention which includes a pH and analyte sensing element.
  • Figure ID is a flow chart schematically illustrating the sensing mechanism of one embodiment of the present invention which includes a temperature sensing element, an analyte sensing element, and a pH sensing element.
  • Figure IE is a flow chart schematically illustrating the sensing mechanism of one embodiment of the present invention which includes a temperature sensing element and a pH and analyte sensing element.
  • Figure 2A schematically illustrates a dual light source, dual detector measurement device in accordance with certain embodiments disclosed herein.
  • Figure 2B schematically illustrates a dual light source measurement device incorporating a microspectrometer and/or spectrometer in accordance with certain embodiments disclosed herein.
  • FIG. 2C schematically illustrates a dual light source, dual detector measurement system incorporating a beam splitter in accordance with certain embodiments disclosed herein.
  • Figure 3 is a cut-away view of a sensor probe wherein a portion of the porous membrane sheath is cut away to expose the optical fiber and hydrogel beneath the membrane.
  • Figure 4 is a cross-sectional view along a longitudinal axis of a sensor probe with a hydrogel disposed in the sensor probe distal to the optical fiber.
  • Figure 5A shows a sensor probe having a series of holes that form a helical configuration.
  • Figure 5B shows a sensor probe having a series of holes drilled or formed at an angle.
  • Figure 5C shows a sensor probe having at least one spiral groove.
  • Figure 5D shows a sensor probe having a series of triangular wedge cut-outs.
  • Figure 6 shows a cross-sectional view of one embodiment of a sensor probe having a cavity in the distal portion of the sensor probe.
  • Figure 7A shows a sensor probe with a protective housing surrounding an indicator system, the protective housing including a tubular mesh surrounded by a polymeric material with an open window leading to the indicator system.
  • Figure 7B shows a sensor probe with a protective housing surrounding an indicator system, the protective housing including a coil surrounded by a polymeric material with an open window leading to the indicator system.
  • Figure 8 displays four plots of fluorescent signal versus glucose concentration at four different temperatures generated by one embodiment of a measurement device disclosed herein.
  • Figure 9 displays the four plots of Figure 8 with each constant temperature plot normalized to the value of its fluorescent signal at 50 mg/dL.
  • Figure 10 displays essentially the same raw data as Figure 8, but instead displays four plots of fluorescent signal versus temperature at four different glucose concentrations.
  • Figure 1 1 displays the fluorescent signal generated by one embodiment of an analyte measuring device disclosed herein at four temperatures and four glucose concentrations.
  • Figure 12 displays a plot of fluorescent signal versus glucose concentration at four temperatures as generated by one embodiment of an analyte measuring device disclosed herein.
  • Figure 13 displays plots of the values of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters versus temperature.
  • Figure 14 displays plots of normalized values of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters versus temperature and displays a best fit line associated with each normalized parameter.
  • Figure 15 compares a plot of glucose concentration as determined by reference measurements with a plot of glucose concentration as determined by one embodiment of an analyte measuring device disclosed herein.
  • Figure 16 displays plots of the ratio of two fluorescent signals versus pH at four glucose concentrations.
  • Figure 17 displays plots of two fluorescent signals at four temperatures and four pH levels.
  • Figure 18 displays plots of two fluorescent signals at four temperatures and four pH levels.
  • Figure 19 displays plots of the ratio of two fluorescent signals versus pH at four temperatures, along with best fit lines corresponding to each temperature.
  • Figure 20 displays plots of the slopes and intercepts of the best fit lines of Figure 19 at each of the temperatures from that figure.
  • Figure 21 compares a plot of pH as determined by reference measurements with a plot of pH as determined by one embodiment of an analyte measuring device disclosed herein.
  • Figure 22 displays plots of two fluorescent signals at five pH levels and four glucose concentrations.
  • Figure 23 displays plots of fluorescent signal versus glucose concentration at five pH levels.
  • Figure 24 displays plots of the values of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters versus pH.
  • Figure 25 displays plots of normalized values of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters versus pH.
  • Figure 26 compares a plot of glucose concentration as determined by reference measurements with a plot of glucose concentration as determined by one embodiment of an analyte measuring device ("GluCath”) disclosed herein.
  • GluCath an analyte measuring device
  • Figure 27 displays a magnified portion of the plots of Figure 26.
  • Whole blood glucose activity is a physiologically significant quantity that may be used to determine proper insulin dosage.
  • Glucose activity represents an estimate of the concentration of bioavailable (or free) glucose in water, blood, or any solution.
  • a patient's whole blood glucose activity level is a physiologically more appropriate quantity by which to estimate insulin dosage, than estimated total blood glucose concentration as determined by the various methods mentioned above.
  • glucose activity is measured through the establishment of a reversible, equilibrium-based, affinity-driven binding interaction between glucose and some moiety capable of binding free glucose.
  • Glucose activity is not substantially affected by the presence of red blood cells, protein or lipid concentration, nor oxygenation levels.
  • glucose activity measurements can be made available in near "real-time.” Furthermore, since glucose activity can be measured on whole blood without dilution, it provides an estimate of bioavailable glucose not polluted by the effects of altering away from biological norms, the osmotic potentials across blood cell membranes.
  • Fluorescent techniques may be used to efficiently and accurately measure the concentration of glucose (and other polyhydroxyl compounds). Oftentimes, these techniques may also be used to measure the concentration of bioavailable glucose in whole blood, i.e. the glucose activity of whole blood. For instance, several attempts have been made to detect glucose by fluorescence using dyes associated with boronic acid groups. Boronate moieties bind glucose reversibly.
  • an analyte sensing element configured to generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of a sample.
  • the analyte sensing element may include at least one light source, an indicator system, and at least one detector.
  • the indicator system (described more fully below) may include at least one type of fluorophore and at least one type of binding moiety.
  • the fluorophore emits a fluorescence having an intensity in response to light from the at least one light source.
  • the binding moiety is capable of binding the analyte and is operably coupled to the fluorophore, such that when the sample contacts the binding moiety the intensity is indicative of the concentration of the analyte.
  • the binding moiety acts as a quencher in the presence of the analyte such that when the binding moiety binds the analyte it interacts with the fluorophore in such a manner as to quench or reduce the fluorescent emission intensity.
  • the binding moiety associates with the fluorophore in the absence of the analyte thereby quenching the fluorescent emission intensity.
  • Analyte binding by the binding moiety causes disassociation from the fluorophore, such that the fluorescent emission intensity increases with increasing concentration of analyte.
  • the analyte sensing element includes at least one detector which may be configured to detect the intensity and generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration in response to the intensity.
  • glucose-sensing chemical indicator systems and glucose sensor configurations for intravascular glucose monitoring include the optical sensors disclosed in U.S. Patent Nos. 5,137,033, 5,512,246, 5,503,770, 6,627,177, 7,417,164 and 7,470,420, and U.S. Patent Publ. Nos. 2008/0188722, 2008/0188725, 2008/0187655, 2008/0305009, 2009/0018426, 2009/0018418, and co-pending U.S. Patent Appl. Nos. 11/296,898, 12/187,248, 12/172,059, 12/274,617, 12/424,902 and 61/184,747; each of which is incorporated herein in its entirety by reference thereto.
  • the concentration being estimated corresponds to the glucose activity of a sample.
  • the sample is whole blood.
  • the embodiments disclosed herein may also measure the concentrations and/or activities of other analytes.
  • disclosed measurement devices may, in some embodiments, be configured to measure the concentrations of other polyhydroxyl-containing organic compounds including, but not limited to, carbohydrates, 1,2-diols, 1,3-diols and the like.
  • the analytes to be measured may include non-carbohydrates.
  • the measurement devices disclosed herein may be configured to estimate the concentration of any analyte which may be bound by a binding moiety, wherein the binding moiety is operably coupled to a fluorophore which emits a fluorescence indicative of the concentration of the analyte after being excited by light of the appropriate wavelength and intensity.
  • concentration refers to both “analyte concentration” as that phrase would be ordinarily used and also to "activity” (in some cases “glucose activity”) as that phrase is described above.
  • Various measurement devices disclosed herein are configured to provide improved estimates of the analyte concentration of a particular solution by taking the temperature and/or the pH of the particular solution into account. Accordingly, some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein may include a temperature sensing element configured to generate a signal indicative of a temperature of the sample. Likewise, some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein may include a pH sensing element configured to a signal indicative of a pH of the sample. Moreover, some embodiments disclosed herein may include both a temperature sensing element and a pH sensing element,
  • a single element may be configured to sense both pH and analyte concentration.
  • this analyte and pH sensing element may be configured to generate two signals, both of which are indicative of analyte concentration and pH.
  • an analyte and pH sensing element may generate a first signal indicative of an analyte concentration of a sample and a pH of the sample, and also generate a second signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and the pH of the sample.
  • some embodiments including an analyte and pH sensing element may further include a temperature sensing element configured to generate a third signal which is indicative of a temperature of the sample.
  • the measurement devices disclosed herein may further include a receiving and processing unit.
  • the receiving and processing unity may be configured to transform a signal indicative of analyte concentration, which has been generated by an analyte sensing element.
  • the receiving and processing unit may transform the signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, as described in detail below.
  • the values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based upon data which may include temperature calibration data and a signal indicative of temperature which has been generated by a temperature sensing element.
  • the values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based upon data which may include pH calibration data and a signal indicative of pH which has been generated by a pH sensing element. In some embodiments, the values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based upon data which may include temperature and pH calibration data, a signal indicative of temperature which has been generated by a temperature sensing element, and a signal indicative of pH which has been generated by a pH sensing element. In some embodiments, the signal indicative of analyte concentration— which is transformed by the receiving and processing unit— has been generated based upon data comprising two signals, each of which was generated by an analyte and pH sensing element, and each of which is indicative of analyte concentration and pH. These two signals may also be utilized to generate a signal indicative of pH which may be used with calibration data to set values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters.
  • Figures 1A through IE are flow charts illustrating the sensing mechanism corresponding to some embodiments of the measurement devices 100 disclosed herein. These flow charts may correspond to the sensing mechanism of an in vitro measurement device for use on the laboratory bench top, or they may correspond to the sensing mechanism of a device used for in vivo analyte sensing. As schematically illustrated in Figure 1A, some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein include at least one analyte sensing element 105, and may include at least one temperature sensing element 120. Other configurations of measurement devices, differing from the configuration illustrated in Figure 1A, are schematically illustrated in Figures IB through IE.
  • Figure IB schematically illustrates a measurement device 100 having an analyte sensing element 105 and a pH sensing element 121, but lacking the temperature sensing element 120 of the configuration illustrated in Figure 1A.
  • Figure 1C schematically illustrates a measurement device 100 having a combination analyte and pH sensing element 1 10, instead of the distinct analyte and pH sensing elements as shown in Figure IB.
  • Figure ID schematically illustrates a configuration having an analyte sensing element 105, a temperature sensing element 120, and a pH sensing element 121.
  • Figure IE schematically illustrates a configuration having the combination analyte and pH sensing element 110 of Figure 1C along with a temperature sensing element 120.
  • the analyte sensing element 105 may include at least one light source 111, at least one detector 115, and an indicator system 113.
  • the indicator system 113 includes the sensing moieties— including at least one fluorophore and at least one binding moiety. In some embodiments, when the sensing moieties contact a sample containing the analyte of interest, a reversible, equilibrium-based, affinity-driven binding interaction between the analyte and the at least one binding moiety is established.
  • emission from the fluorophore is indicative of the concentration of analyte in the sample.
  • emission from the fluorophore may also be indicative of the pH of the sample. If this is the case, fluorescent emissions may be used to determine pH and analyte concentration as described in U.S. Application No. 11/671,880, entitled “Optical Determination of pH and Glucose,” filed February 6, 2007, hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety.
  • the fluorescent emission generated by the fluorophore is detected by the detector 1 15 which generates a signal indicative of the emission (and thus also the analyte concentration and/or the pH) which is passed to the receiving and processing unit 125.
  • the receiving and processing unit 125 is configured to estimate the concentration of the analyte in the sample based on one or more signals indicative of analyte concentration— such as the intensities of the fluorescent emissions.
  • the receiving and processing unit 125 may be further configured to generate temperature and/or pH corrected estimates of analyte concentration.
  • the receiving and processing unit 125 may correct for temperature by receiving and taking into account one or more signals indicative of temperature generated by the temperature sensing element 120, as schematically illustrated in Figures 1A, ID, and IE.
  • the receiving and processing unit 125 may correct for pH by receiving and taking into account one or more signals indicative of pH generated either by the pH sensing element 121, as schematically illustrated in Figures IB and ID, or by the analyte and pH sensing element 110.
  • the receiving and processing unit 125 may employ various methods and algorithms of adjusting the estimated concentration based on the signal indicative of temperature, or the signal indicative of pH, or both, as described in further detail below.
  • Estimated concentrations may be displayed in a display unit 126 and/or stored in a storage unit 127, as schematically illustrated in Figures 1A through IE.
  • any quantity related to analyte concentration (such as quantities derived in whole or in part from measurements of optical intensity) may be displayed in the display unit 126 and/or stored in the storage unit 127, including, but not limited to the measured fluorescent intensities emitted by the fluorophores, the temperature of the sample, and the pH of the sample.
  • some embodiments of the measurement device 100 include one or more filters 112 located between the light source 1 11 and indicator system 113, and/or one or more filters 1 14 located between the indicator system 1 13 and the detector 1 15.
  • the filter 112 may serve to select particular wavelengths of light for excitation of the fluorophore, while the filter 1 14 may serve to select particular wavelengths of light for detection.
  • Other optical components may also be utilized (that are not shown in Figures 1A through IE) including, but not limited to, mirrors, collimating and/or focusing lenses, beam splitters, etc. (See, e.g., Figures 2A, 2B, and 2C below.)
  • the measurement device 100 may include a controller unit (not shown in Figures 1 A through IE) which controls various operations of the measurement device 100 including, but not limited to, control of the light sources, control of detectors, and responding to operator input or actions.
  • the controller unit can be any type known in the art and capable of controlling the measuring device including, but not limited to, a microprocessor, an embedded processor, a multiprocessor, a general purpose computer, a special purpose processor, a microcontroller, a programmable gate array or any combination thereof.
  • Various measurement devices disclosed herein include an analyte sensing element or an element capable of sensing both analyte concentration and pH— referred to herein as an analyte and pH sensing element.
  • the latter dual purpose elements are schematically illustrated, for example, in Figures 1C and IE.
  • various embodiments of the measurement devices 100 disclosed herein may include an analyte sensing element 105, and a pH sensing element 121 separate from the analyte sensing element 105.
  • the pH sensing element 121 When the pH sensing element 121 is distinct from the analyte sensing element 105, it may consist of any of a number of standard pH sensing devices which are known in the art so long as the device is properly sized and is capable of generating a signal indicative of pH which exhibits sufficient accuracy and precision to serve as a basis for applying pH correction to a signal indicative of analyte concentration.
  • a pH sensing element is not needed for this purpose and may be omitted.
  • An analyte sensing element may be configured to generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of a sample and may include at least one light source, an indicator system, and at least one detector.
  • the indicator system (described more fully below) may include at least one type of fluorophore and at least one type of binding moiety (each described in greater detail below), and in some embodiments, an immobilizing medium whose presence may prevent some of the fluorophores and/or some of the binding moieties from freely diffusing through the sample (as described in greater detail below).
  • the fluorophore emits a fluorescence having an intensity in response to light from the at least one light source.
  • the binding moiety is capable of binding the analyte and is operably coupled to the fluorophore, such that when the sample contacts the binding moiety the intensity is indicative of the concentration of the analyte.
  • the analyte sensing element includes at least one detector which may be configured to detect the intensity and generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample in response to the intensity.
  • analyte and pH sensing element may be configured to generate one or more signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a sample and the pH of the sample.
  • an analyte and pH sensing element may include at least one light source, an indicator system, and at least one detector, similarly to the analyte sensing elements described in the preceding paragraph.
  • the indicator system may include at least one type of fluorophore and at least one type of binding moiety (each described in greater detail below), and in some embodiments, an immobilizing medium whose presence may prevent some of the fluorophores and/or some of the binding moieties from freely diffusing through the sample (as described in greater detail below).
  • the fluorophore emits a fluorescence having an intensity in response to light from the at least one light source.
  • the binding moiety is capable of binding the analyte and is operably coupled to the fluorophore, such that when the sample contacts the binding moiety the intensity is indicative of the concentration of analyte in the sample and the pH of the sample.
  • the analyte and pH sensing element includes at least one detector which may be configured to detect the intensity and generate one or more signals indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and the pH of the sample in response to the intensity.
  • Some of the measurement devices disclosed herein only employ a single type of fluorophore and a single light source. However, it should be understood that some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein employ more than one type of fluorophore. Furthermore, some embodiments of measurement devices employing multiple types of fluorophores may also employ more than one light source. Similarly, embodiments employing more than one type of fluorophore may also employ more than one detector. In certain such embodiments, the single detector may be a spectrometer. [0070] However, dual light source and dual detector configurations are not necessarily limited to configurations utilizing multiple fluorophores, as these dual light source/detector configurations may offer other advantages.
  • a dual light source configuration might advantageously allow one light source to serve as a reference for the other, or a dual light source configuration might be useful for measurement devices employing ratiometric pH determination as disclosed in U.S. Patent No. 7,751,863, entitled "Optical Determination of pH and Glucose,” which is hereby incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • Methods and/or algorithms for determining pH based on the ratio of two fluorescent emission signals are discussed below, as well as described in the aforementioned patent. In some embodiments, these methods may be implemented in a measurement device employing a combination analyte and pH sensing element which utilizes a dual light source configuration, as described below with reference to Figures 2A through 2C.
  • FIG. 2A schematically illustrates a two light source measurement device in accordance with certain preferred embodiments of the present invention.
  • the two light sources, 301A and 301B each generate excitation light.
  • each of the two light sources 301 A and 30 IB generates excitation light over a different range of wavelengths.
  • the excitation light generated by light source 301A falls within a wavelength range appropriate to cause an emission of a first type
  • the excitation light generated by light source 30 IB falls within a wavelength range appropriate to cause an emission of a second type.
  • the ranges are partially overlapping, while in other embodiments, the ranges are fully non-overlapping.
  • the excitation light generated by light sources 301A and 301B may be transmitted (as illustrated) through collimator lenses 302A and 302B.
  • the collimator lenses 302A and 302B may be aspheric lenses, but other types of collimator lenses may also be employed.
  • each interference filter 303A and 303B may attenuate or block a portion of the wavelength ranges generated by light sources other than the corresponding light source 301 A and 301B.
  • interference filter 303A may pass light generated by light source 301A, but may severely attenuate light generated by light source 301B.
  • Interference filter 303B may function analogously.
  • each interference filter 303A and 303B blocks the wavelength range that overlaps with the wavelength range corresponding to emission by the one or more types of fluorophores.
  • an interference filter may in some embodiments preferably be used to narrow the band of blue excitation, because the blue excitation light may comprise both blue and green light.
  • An unfiltered excitation blue that comprises green light can produce inaccurate green emission signal because the green light from the excitation light will add to the green emission signal of the fluorophore to produce a green light of greater intensity.
  • the interference filters 303A and 303B can be short or long pass filters that block all wavelengths beyond a certain maximum or minimum wavelength.
  • the interference filters 303A and 303B can be band pass filters that only allow a particular band of wavelengths to pass through the filters.
  • the measurement device employs interference filters 303A and 303B that are band pass filters because, in certain embodiments, the light sources 301A and 301B generate light of overlapping wavelength ranges.
  • the use of non-overlapping band pass filters 303A and 303B may allow the measurement device to generate excitation light in distinct bands such that light generated by the light source 301 A selectively creates only excitation of a first type, and light generated by 30 IB selectively creates only excitation of a second type. In this manner, in some embodiments, each light source may be tailored to create a particular type of emission.
  • light exiting from interference filters 303A and 303B may be focused (as illustrated) by focusing lenses 304A and 304B into fiber optic lines 305A and 305B.
  • the fiber optic lines 305A and 305B carry the filtered excitation light to the indicator system 307, which is contained within a sensor probe 200.
  • the sensor probe 200 includes a protective housing 500 which serves to protect the indicator system 307 contained within the sensor probe 200.
  • the indicator system is immobilized in an immobilizing medium within the sensor probe 200, as described herein.
  • the fiber optic lines 305A and 305B merge into a single fiber 306 that is continuous with the sensor probe 200.
  • the fiber optic lines 305A and 305B remain distinct (although not shown in Figure 2A). In certain embodiments employing two types of fluorophores, the fiber optic lines 305A and 305B may remain distinct and be configured so as to keep the two types of fluorophores spatially distinct/separated so that each type of fluorophore may only interact with light traveling to the indicator system down a single optical fiber (that is light generated from one of the light sources).
  • the fiber optic lines 305A and 305B may be kept distinct so that one line may be configured so that light traveling down the line never interacts with any fluorophore— in this manner creating a reference signal and keeping it free from optical contamination by the optically emitting fluorophore interacting with light travelling down the other fiber optic line.
  • the cross-sections of the fibers may vary (as illustrated) from a bundle of fibers surrounding a central optical fiber 306A to a single fiber 306B.
  • each fiber optic outlet line 309A and 309B substantially carries light corresponding to one type of fluorescent emission.
  • outlet line 309A carries light away from the sensor probe 200 substantially consisting of a first type of fluorescent emission
  • outlet line 309B carries light away from the sensor probe 200 substantially consisting of a second type of fluorescent emission.
  • a portion of the light transmitted back out of the sensor probe 200 into the fiber optic outlet lines 309A and 309B is light that has been reflected by the mirror 308.
  • other embodiments may lack a mirror.
  • the fiber optic outlet lines 309A and 309B are augmented by including two interference filters 312A and 312B; and two detectors 313A and 313B.
  • the interference filter 312A is configured to substantially block the excitation light generated by light source 301A (and, in some embodiments, additionally block the excitation and emission/fluorescence wavelengths corresponding to light source 30 IB) and substantially pass the fluorescence emitted and generated by the indicator system in response to irradiation by light source 301A. As a result, this fluorescence passes to detector 313A where it is detected.
  • the detector 313A may be any device capable of measuring fluorescent intensity at an appropriate wavelength or over an appropriate range of wavelengths, including, but not limited to, detectors consisting of one or more photodiodes.
  • the detector 313A produces a signal that is amplified by the amplifier 314A and converted into a digital signal by analog-to-digital converter 315A and transmitted to a receiving and processing unit 316.
  • the receiving and processing unit 316 may comprise a data processing device of any type known in the art, for example, a microprocessor, an embedded processor, a multiprocessor, a general purpose computer, a special purpose processor, any computational device, a digital signal processor, a microcontroller, a programmable gate array or any combination thereof.
  • the interference filter 312B, detector 313B, amplifier 314B, and analog-to- digital converter 315B may function in a similar manner with respect to fluorescence emitted and generated by the indicator system 307 in response to irradiation by light source 301B.
  • the receiving and processing unit 316 after receiving digital signals from the analog-to-digital converters 315A and 315B may employ various calculation schemes disclosed herein to estimate an analyte concentration, and in some embodiments, the glucose concentration of a sample.
  • the receiving and processing unit 316 may employ a temperature correction and/or pH correction method or algorithm such as those described in detail below.
  • the receiving and processing unit 316 may transmit data and/or results to a storage unit which may store the data and/or results (e.g. on an optical or magnetic disc or other digital medium). In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit 316 may transmit data and/or results to a display unit which may display the data and/or results (e.g. on a print-out or display screen).
  • FIG. 2B Another embodiment of an measurement device is schematically illustrated in Figure 2B. Like the device schematically illustrated in Figure 2A, the device depicted in Figure 2B is a two light source measurement device. However, the device depicted in Figure 2B differs from that depicted in Figure 2A in that it utilizes a spectrophotometer 310 instead of the multiple detectors 312A and 312B shown in Figure 2A.
  • the spectrophotometer may be a ultraviolet/visible microspectrometer such as those manufactured by Boehringer Ingelheim or Ocean Optic Inc. However, in principle, any spectrophotometer which measures optical intensity over the appropriate wavelength range(s) may be used.
  • the spectrophotometer 310 receives light from the indicator system 307 via a single fiber optic outlet line 309.
  • a spectrophotometer 310 such as that depicted in Figure 2B is capable of measuring optical intensity over a broader range of wavelengths than the detectors 312A and 312B.
  • one spectrophotometer 310 fed by a single optical fiber 309 may provide the detection functionality of multiple detectors and in some embodiments much more flexibility.
  • there are other device design tradeoffs such as, for example, potential cost, complexity, size, and power requirements.
  • the filters 312A and 312B are also absent from the measurement device depicted in Figure 2B.
  • the amplifiers 314A and 314B are also absent from the measurement device depicted in Figure 2B.
  • Similar functionality is provided, in some embodiments, by the spectrophotometer 310 itself.
  • the spectrophotometer 310 transmits data and/or results to a receiving and processing unit 316 as was described in reference to Figure 2A.
  • the receiving and processing units 316 of Figures 2A and 2B may function similarly, as described above, depending on the embodiment.
  • FIG. 2C Yet another embodiment of an analyte measuring device is schematically illustrated in Figure 2C.
  • the device depicted in Figure 2C is a two light source measurement device.
  • the device depicted in Figure 2C utilizes a single fiber optic outlet line 309 which transmits light to a single collimator lens 317 and then on to beam splitters 318.
  • the beam splitter 318 substantially reflects light generated by a first type of fluorescent emission, and substantially transmits light generated by a second type of fluorescent emission. The reflected light is transmitted to a detector 313A, which generates an analogue signal indicative of the intensity of the reflected light.
  • the signal is amplified by the amplifier 314A and transmitted to the analog- to-digital converter 315A where it is digitized.
  • the digital signal is then transmitted to the receiving and processing unit 316.
  • Light transmitted by the beam splitter 318 is detected by the detector 313B, amplified by the amplifier 314B, digitized by the analog-to-digital converter 315B, and transmitted to the receiving and processing unit 316 in parallel fashion to the light reflected by the beam splitter 318.
  • the receiving and processing unit 316 may be a data processing device of any type known in the art, for example, a microprocessor, an embedded processor, a multiprocessor, a general purpose computer, a special purpose processor, any computational device, a digital signal processor, a microcontroller, a programmable gate array or any combination thereof.
  • the beam splitter 318 may be an interference filter designed to work at a substantially forty-five degree angle, as shown in Figure 2C.
  • the beam splitter 318 comprises a glass surface with a coating that reflects light having a certain wavelength and transmits all other light.
  • the beam splitter 318 can be positioned at a substantially forty-five degree angle relative the direction of the light traveling from the collimator lens 317.
  • the beam splitter 318 is configured in such a way that light generated by different types of fluorescent emission are detected separately by a dedicated detector 313A and 313B.
  • FIGS. 2A, 2B, and 2C are merely illustrative of the types of device configurations which are possible. These example embodiments are not meant to be exhaustive and the particular design chosen is not necessarily critical to the working of the various measurement devices disclosed herein.
  • the measurement device may contain a temperature sensing element, such as, for example, a thermistor or a thermocouple, located within the sensor probe 200.
  • a temperature sensing element such as, for example, a thermistor or a thermocouple, located within the sensor probe 200.
  • the temperature sensing element is located at or near the analyte sensing chemistry (i.e. the indicator system) such that the temperature being measured is characteristic of the temperature of the analyte solution where the concentration is being measured.
  • the temperature sensing element may be co-located with the indicator system within a distal tip of the sensor probe.
  • a suitable temperature sensing element is preferably small enough such that the sensor probe 200 does not have to be increased in size substantially to accommodate it.
  • the temperature sensing element is particularly important when the analyte sensing chemistry, such as a fluorophore system, is affected by temperature change.
  • the fluorescence intensity emitted by the fluorophore system is dependent on the temperature of the fluorophore system.
  • a fluorophore based glucose sensing chemistry may generate signals indicative of glucose concentration which are effected by the temperature at which the sensing is performed, and knowledge of the effect of temperature on these signals may be used to generate estimates of glucose concentration which are corrected for temperature.
  • FIG 3 illustrates in greater detail a sensor probe 200 in accordance with an embodiment of the present invention.
  • the sensor probe 200 comprises an optical fiber 10 with a distal end 12 disposed in a porous membrane sheath 14.
  • the optical fiber 10 has cavities, such as holes 6A, in the fiber optic wall that can be formed by, for example, mechanical means such as drilling or cutting.
  • the holes 6A in the optical fiber 10 can be filled with a suitable compound, such as a polymer.
  • the polymer is a hydrogel 8.
  • the optical fiber 10 does not have holes 6A, and instead, the hydrogel 8 is disposed in a space distal to the distal end 12 of the optical fiber 10 and proximal to the mirror 23.
  • the sensor probe 200 is configured to generate a signal indicative of glucose concentration.
  • the sensor probe 200 is configured for intravascular deployment.
  • the porous membrane sheath 14 can be made from a polymeric material such as polyethylene, polycarbonate, polysulfone or polypropylene. Other materials can also be used to make the porous membrane sheath 14 such as zeolites, ceramics, metals, or combinations of these materials. In some embodiments, the porous membrane sheath 14 may be nanoporous. In other embodiments, the porous membrane sheath 14 may be microporous. In still other embodiments, the porous membrane sheath 14 may be mesoporous. [0089] In some embodiments as shown in Figure 4, the porous membrane sheath 14 is attached to the optical fiber 10 by a connector 16. For example, the connector 16 can be an elastic collar that holds the porous membrane sheath 14 in place by exerting a compressive force on the optical fiber 10, as shown in Figure 4. In other embodiments, the connector 16 is an adhesive or a thermal weld.
  • a mirror 23 and a temperature sensing element such as a thermistor 25 may be placed within the porous membrane sheath 14 distal the distal end 12 of the optical fiber 10.
  • Thermistor leads 27 can be made to run in a space between the optical fiber 10 and porous membrane sheath 14.
  • a thermistor 25 is shown, other devices such as a thermocouple, pressure transducer, an oxygen sensor, a carbon dioxide sensor or a pH sensor for example can be used instead.
  • the distal end 18 of the porous membrane sheath 14 is open and can be sealed with, for example, an adhesive 20.
  • the adhesive 20 can comprise a polymerizable material that can fill the distal end 18 and then be polymerized into a plug.
  • the distal end 18 can be thermally welded by melting a portion of the polymeric material on the distal end 18, closing the opening and allowing the melted polymeric material to resolidify.
  • a polymeric plug 21 can be inserted into the distal end 18 and thermally heated to weld the plug to the porous membrane sheath 14.
  • Thermoplastic polymeric materials such as polyethylene, polypropylene, polycarbonate and polysulfone are particularly suited for thermal welding.
  • the distal end 18 of the porous membrane sheath 14 can be sealed against the optical fiber 10.
  • the sensor probe 200 can be vacuum filled with a first solution comprising a monomer, a crosslinker and a first initiator.
  • a first solution comprising a monomer, a crosslinker and a first initiator.
  • Vacuum filling of a polymerizable solution through a porous membrane and into a cavity in a sensor is described in detail in US Patent No. 5,618,587 to Markle et al.; incorporated herein in its entirety by reference thereto.
  • the first solution is allowed to fill the cavity 6 within the optical fiber 10.
  • the first solution is aqueous and the monomer, the crosslinker and the first initiator are soluble in water.
  • the monomer is acrylamide
  • the crosslinker is bisacrylamide
  • the first initiator is ammonium persulfate.
  • the monomer is dimethylacrylamide or N- hydroxymethylacrylamide.
  • the first solution further comprises an analyte indicator system comprising a fluorophore and an analyte binding moiety that functions to quench the fluorescent emission of the fluorophore by an amount related to the concentration of the analyte.
  • analyte indicator system comprising a fluorophore and an analyte binding moiety that functions to quench the fluorescent emission of the fluorophore by an amount related to the concentration of the analyte.
  • the fluorophore and analyte binding moiety are immobilized during polymerization, such that the fluorophore and analyte binding moiety are operably coupled.
  • the fluorophore and analyte binding moiety are covalently linked.
  • the indicator system chemistry may also be covalently linked to the polymeric matrix.
  • the optical fiber 10 and the first solution filled porous membrane sheath 14 and cavity 6 are transferred to and immersed into a second solution comprising a second initiator.
  • the second solution is aqueous and the second initiator is tetramethylethylenediamine (TEMED).
  • the second solution further comprises the same fluorescent dye and/or quencher found in the first solution and in substantially the same concentrations. By having the fluorescent dye and quencher in both the first solution and the second solution, diffusion of fluorescent dye and quencher out of the first solution and into the second solution can be reduced.
  • the second solution further comprises monomer in substantially the same concentration as in the first solution. This reduces diffusion of monomer out of the first solution by reducing the monomer gradient between the first solution and the second solution.
  • the first initiator and the second initiator can react together to generate a radical.
  • the first initiator and the second initiator react together in a redox reaction.
  • the radical can be generated by thermal decomposition, photolytic initiation or initiation by ionizing radiation.
  • the radical may be generated anywhere in the first solution. Once the radical is generated, the radical can then initiate polymerization of the monomer and crosslinker in the first solution.
  • the polymerization proceeds generally from the interface between the first and second solutions to the interior of the porous membrane sheath 14 and towards the cavity in the optical fiber 10. Rapid initiation of polymerization can help reduce the amount of first initiator that can diffuse from the first solution and into the second solution. Reducing the amount of first initiator that diffuses out of the first solution helps reduce polymerization of monomer outside the porous membrane sheath 14 which helps in forming a smooth external surface. Polymerization of the monomer and crosslinker results in a hydrogel 8 that in some embodiments substantially immobilizes the indicator system, forming the sensor probe 200. Further variations on polymerization methodologies are disclosed in U.S. Patent Publ. No. 2008/0187655; incorporated herein in its entirety by reference thereto.
  • the sensor probe 200 is a solid optical fiber with a series holes 6A drilled straight through the sides of the optical fiber.
  • the holes 6A are filled with the hydrogels 8.
  • the series of holes 6A that are drilled through the sensor probe 200 are evenly spaced horizontally and evenly rotated around the sides of the sensor probe 200 to form a spiral or helical configuration.
  • the series of holes 6A are drilled through the diameter of the sensor probe 200.
  • the sensor probe 200 is a solid optical fiber with a series of holes 6A drilled through the sides of the fiber at an angle.
  • the series of holes 6A drilled at an angle, which are filled with hydrogel 8, are evenly spaced horizontally and evenly rotated around the sides the sensor probe 200.
  • the optical fiber comprises a groove 6B along the length of the optical fiber, wherein the groove 6B is filled with hydrogel 8.
  • the depth of the groove 6B extends to the center of the optical fiber.
  • the groove 6B spirals around the optical fiber.
  • the groove 6B spirals around the optical fiber to complete at least one rotation.
  • the sensor probe 200 is a solid optical fiber with triangular wedges 6C cut from the fiber.
  • the triangular wedge areas 6C are filled with hydrogel 8.
  • the triangular wedges cut-outs 6C are evenly spaced horizontally and around the sides of the sensor probe 200.
  • all light traveling in the sensor probe 200 is transmitted through at least one hole 6A or groove 6B filled with hydrogel 8.
  • the sensor probe 200 comprises an optical fiber 10 having a distal end 12, an atraumatic tip portion 134 having a proximal end 136 and a distal end 138, a cavity 6 between the distal end 12 of the optical fiber 10 and the proximal end 136 of the atraumatic tip portion 134, and a rod 140 connecting the distal end 12 of the optical fiber 10 to the proximal end 136 of the atraumatic tip portion 134.
  • a hydrogel 8 containing the sensing chemistry for example a fluorophore and quencher, fills the cavity 6.
  • a temperature sensing element 25 such as thermocouple or thermistor.
  • a selectively permeable membrane 14 that allows passage of the analyte being detected/sensed into and out of the hydrogel 8. It should, of course, be understood that the sensor probe 200 may be modified to generate signals indicative of the analyte concentration of various analytes by selecting, for example, an appropriate sensing chemistry, and if necessary, choosing an appropriate selectively permeable membrane 14.
  • the proximal portion of the sensor probe 200 comprises the proximal portion of the optical fiber 10.
  • the diameter, Dl, of the distal portion of the sensor 2 is greater than the diameter, D2, of the proximal portion of the sensor 2.
  • the diameter Dl of the distal portion of the sensor probe 200 can be between about 0.0080 inches and 0.020 inches, while the diameter D2 of the proximal portion of the sensor probe 200 can be between about 0.005 inches to 0.015 inches.
  • the diameter Dl of the distal portion of the sensor probe 200 is about 0.012 inches, while the diameter D2 of the proximal portion of the sensor probe 200 is about 0.010 inches.
  • the indicator system includes the sensing moieties— including, in some embodiments, at least one type of fluorophore and at least one type of binding moiety.
  • the sensing moieties contact a sample containing the analyte of interest, a reversible, equilibrium-based, affinity-driven binding interaction between the analyte and the at least one type of binding moiety is established.
  • This binding interaction alters the binding moieties' relationship with the fiuorophores, such that when the fluorophores are excited by light from the at least one light source, their fluorescent emission varies with the extent to which analyte has been bound by the binding moieties.
  • emission from the one or more types of fluorophores is indicative of the concentration of analyte in the sample.
  • the indicator system includes at least one type of fluorophore which emits a fluorescence having an intensity in response to light from at least one light source.
  • the intensity is detectable by at least one detector.
  • the indicator system further includes at least one type of binding moiety capable of binding the analyte.
  • the at least one type of binding moiety is typically operably coupled to the at least one type of fluorophore such that when the sample contacts the at least one type of binding moiety the intensity (emitted in response to light from the at least one light source, as described above) is indicative of the concentration of the analyte.
  • the indicator system may include an immobilizing medium configured to prevent some of the fluorophores and/or some of the binding moieties from freely diffusing through the sample. Fluorophores
  • Fluorophore refers to a substance that when illuminated by light at a particular wavelength emits light at a longer wavelength; i.e. it fluoresces. Fluorophores include but are not limited to organic dyes, organometallic compounds, metal chelates, fluorescent conjugated polymers, quantum dots or nanoparticles and combinations of the above. Fluorophores may be discrete moieties or substituents attached to a polymer.
  • Fluorophores that may be used in preferred embodiments are capable of being excited by light of wavelength at or greater than about 400 nm, with a Stokes shift large enough that the excitation and emission wavelengths are separable by at least 10 nm. In some embodiments, the separation between the excitation and emission wavelengths may be equal to or greater than about 30 nm. These fluorophores are preferably susceptible to quenching by electron acceptor molecules, such as viologens, and are resistant to photo-bleaching. They are also preferably stable against photo-oxidation, hydrolysis and biodegradation.
  • the fluorophore may be a discrete compound.
  • the fluorophore may be a pendant group or a chain unit in a water-soluble or water-dispersible polymer having molecular weight of about 10,000 Daltons or greater, forming a dye-polymer unit.
  • such dye-polymer unit may also be non-covalently associated with a water-insoluble polymer matrix M 1 and is physically immobilized within the polymer matrix M 1 , wherein M 1 is permeable to or in contact with analyte solution.
  • the dye on the dye-polymer unit may be negatively charged, and the dye-polymer unit may be immobilized as a complex with a cationic water- soluble polymer, wherein said complex is permeable to or in contact with the analyte solution.
  • the dye may be one of the polymeric derivatives of hydroxypyrene trisulfonic acid.
  • the polymeric dyes may be water-soluble, water-swellable or dispersible in water.
  • the polymeric dyes may also be cross-linked. In preferred embodiments, the dye has a negative charge.
  • the dye molecule may be covalently bonded to the water-insoluble polymer matrix M 1 , wherein said M 1 is permeable to or in contact with the analyte solution.
  • the dye molecule bonded to M 1 may form a structure M'-L'-Dye.
  • L 1 is a hydrolytically stable covalent linker that covalently connects the sensing moiety to the polymer or matrix.
  • the dye is bonded to a polymer matrix through the sulfonamide functional groups.
  • useful dyes include pyranine derivatives (e.g. hydroxypyrene trisulfonamide derivatives and the like), which have the following formula: [0109] wherein R 1 , R 2 , R
  • X 1 is -OH, -OCH 3 COOH, -CONH 2 , -S0 3 H, -NH 2 , or OMe; and n is between about 70 and 10,000.
  • the dyes may be bonded to a polymer through the sulfonamide functional groups.
  • the dye may be one of the polymeric derivatives of hydroxypyrene trisulfonic acid.
  • the fluorescent dye may be 8- hydroxypyrene-l,3,6-trisulfonate (HPTS).
  • the counter-ions can be H + , Na + , or any other cation.
  • HPTS has a molecular weight of less than 500 Daltons, so it will not stay within the polymer matrix, but it can be used with an anion exclusion membrane.
  • the dyes may be used with a quencher comprising boronic acid, such as 3,3'-oBBV.
  • dyes of the following generic structure may serve as suitable fluorophores:
  • R is H :
  • n 1-4
  • a " is an anionic group selected from the group consisting of S0 3 " , HP0 3 " , C0 2 and
  • M* is a cationic group selected from the group consisting of ⁇ 1" , an alkali metal ion, Li + , Na + , K + , Rb + , Cs + , Fr + , an onium ion and NR "1" , wherein R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkylaryl and aromatic groups);
  • R 4 is—C-R 5 ;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of n and n n n ; wherein n is equal to 1-10, n' is equal to 2-4 and Y is selected from the group consisting of NH and O;
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of NHR 7 , OR 7 and C0 2 H;
  • R 7 is H or an ethylenically unsaturated group selected from the group consisting of methacryloyl, acryloyl, styryl, acrylamide and methacrylamido.
  • dyes of the following generic structure may serve as suitable fluorophores:
  • R 3 is— (CH 2 ) n — A " M +
  • n 1 wherein A " is an anionic group selected from the group consisting of S0 3 " , HP0 3 and
  • W is a cationic group selected from the group consisting of ⁇ 1" , an alkali metal ion, Li + , Na + , K + , Rb + , Cs + , Fr + , an onium ion and NR 4 " , wherein R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkylaryl and aromatic groups);
  • R 4 is— C-R 5 ;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of
  • n is equal to 1-10, n' is equal to 2-4;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of NHR 10 , OR 10 and C0 2 H;
  • R 10 is H or an ethylenically unsaturated group selected from the group consisting of methacryloyl, acryloyl, styryl, acrylamido and methacrylamido.
  • the fluorescent dye may be polymers of 8-acetoxy- pyrene-l,3,6-N, N',N"-tris-(methacrylpropylamidosulfonamide) (acetoxy-HPTS-MA):
  • dyes such as acetoxy-HPTS-MA (above) having no anionic groups may not give very strong glucose response when operably coupled to a viologen quencher, particularly a viologen quencher having only a single boronic acid moiety.
  • the fluorescent dye may be 8-hydroxy-pyrene- 1,3,6- N, N',N"-tris-(carboxypropylsulfonamide) (HPTS-C0 2 ):
  • the fluorescent dye may be 8-hydroxy-pyrene- 1,3,6- N, N',N"-tris-(methoxypolyethoxyethyl (-125) sulfonamide) (HPTS-PEG):
  • dyes such as HPTS-PEG (above) having no anionic groups may not provide a very strong glucose response when operably coupled to a viologen quencher, particularly a viologen quencher having only a single boronic acid moiety.
  • Representative dyes as discrete compounds are the tris adducts formed by reacting 8-acetoxypyrene-l,3,6-trisulfonyl chloride (HPTS-Cl) with an amino acid, such as amino butyric acid.
  • Hydroxypyrene trisulfonamide dyes bonded to a polymer and bearing one or more anionic groups are most preferred, such as copolymers of 8-hydroxypyrene-l-N- (methacrylamidopropylsulfonamido)-N',N"-3,6-bis(carboxypropylsulfonamide) HPTS-C0 2 -MA with HEMA, PEGMA, and the like.
  • the fluorescent dye may be HPTS-TriCys-MA:
  • This dye is also referred to as just HPTS-Cys-MA.
  • the dye may be used with a quencher comprising boronic acid, such as 3,3'-oBBV.
  • substitutions other than Cys-MA on the HPTS core are consistent with aspects of the present invention, as long as the substitutions are negatively charged and have a polymerizable group.
  • Either L or D stereoisomers of cysteine may be used.
  • only one or two of the sulfonic acids may be substituted.
  • other counter-ions besides NBu 4 + may be used, including positively charged metals, e.g., Na + .
  • the sulfonic acid groups may be replaced with e.g., phosphoric, carboxylic, etc. functional groups.
  • HPTS-LysMA Another suitable dye is HPTS-LysMA, which is pictured below as follows:
  • soluble copolymers of 8-acetoxypyrene-l,3,6-N, N', N"-tris(methacrylamidopropylsulfonamide) with HEMA, PEGMA, or other hydrophilic comonomers include soluble copolymers of 8-acetoxypyrene-l,3,6-N, N', N"-tris(methacrylamidopropylsulfonamide) with HEMA, PEGMA, or other hydrophilic comonomers.
  • a blocking group that can be removed by hydrolysis after completion of polymerization.
  • suitable blocking groups as for example, acetoxy, trifluoroacetoxy, and the like, are well known in the art.
  • Fluorescent dyes including HPTS and its derivatives are known and many have been used in analyte detection. See e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,653,141, 6,627,177, 5,512,246, 5,137,833, 6,800,451, 6,794,195, 6,804,544, 6,002,954, 6,319,540, 6,766,183, 5,503,770, and 5,763,238; and co-pending U.S. Patent Application Nos. 11/296,898, 60/833,081, and 1 1/671,880; each of which is incorporated herein in its entirety by reference thereto.
  • SNARF and SNAFL dyes from Molecular Probes may also be useful fluorophores in accordance with aspects of the present invention.
  • the structures of SNARF-1 and SNAFL- 1 are shown below.
  • a set of isomeric water-soluble fluorescent probes based on both the 6-aminoquinolinium and boronic acid moieties which show spectral shifts and intensity changes with pH, in a wavelength-ratiometric and colorimetric manner may be useful in accordance with some embodiments of the present invention (See e.g., Badugu, R. et al. 2005 Talanta 65 (3):762-768; and Badugu, R. et al. 2005 Bioorg. Med. Chem. 13 (1):113-119); incorporated herein in its entirety by reference.
  • TSPP tetrakis(4-sulfophenyl)porphine
  • the analyte binding moiety provides the at least dual functionality of being able to bind analyte and being able to modulate the apparent concentration of the fluorophore (e.g., detected as a change in emission signal intensity) in a manner related to the amount of analyte binding.
  • the analyte binding moiety is associated with a quencher. "Quencher” refers to a compound that reduces the emission of a fluorophore when in its presence.
  • Quencher (Q) is selected from a discrete compound, a reactive intermediate which is convertible to a second discrete compound or to a polymerizable compound or Q is a pendant group or chain unit in a polymer prepared from said reactive intermediate or polymerizable compound, which polymer is water-soluble or dispersible or is an insoluble polymer, said polymer is optionally crosslinked.
  • the binding moiety that provides glucose recognition in the embodiments is an aromatic boronic acid.
  • the binding moiety may be a quencher comprising a boronic acid functionalized to either a pyridinium cation (or salt) as disclosed in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2008/0305009 or a polyviologen as disclosed in US. Patent Application Publication No. 2009/0081803; each of which is hereby incorporated herein in its entirety by reference thereto.
  • the boronic acid is covalently bonded to a conjugated nitrogen-containing heterocyclic aromatic bis-onium structure (e.g., a viologen).
  • Viologen refers generally to compounds having the basic structure of a nitrogen containing conjugated N-substituted heterocyclic aromatic bis-onium salt, such as 2,2'-, 3,3'- or 4,4'-N,N' bis-(benzyl) bipyridium dihalide (i.e., dichloride, bromide chloride), etc. Viologen also includes the substituted phenanthroline compounds.
  • the boronic acid substituted quencher preferably has a pKa of between about 4 and 9, and reacts reversibly with glucose in aqueous media at a pH from about 6.8 to 7.8 to form boronate esters. The extent of reaction is related to glucose concentration in the medium.
  • a useful bis-onium salt is compatible with the analyte solution and capable of producing a detectable change in the fluorescent emission of the dye in the presence of the analyte to be detected.
  • a binding moiety may comprise an analyte binding protein operably coupled to a fluorophore, such as the glucose binding proteins disclosed in U.S. Patent Nos. 6,197,534, 6,227,627, 6,521,447, 6,855,556, 7,064,103, 7,316,909, 7,326,538, 7,345,160, and 7,496,392, U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2003/0232383, 2005/0059097, 2005/0282225, 2009/0104714, 2008/0311675, 2008/0261255, 2007/0136825, 2007/0207498, and 2009/0048430, and PCT International Publication Nos. WO 2009/021052, WO 2009/036070, WO 2009/021026, WO 2009/021039, WO 2003/060464, and WO 2008/072338 which are hereby incorporated by reference herein in their entireties.
  • a fluorophore such as the glucose binding proteins disclosed in U.S. Patent No
  • Bis-onium salts in the embodiments of this invention are prepared from conjugated heterocyclic aromatic di-nitrogen compounds.
  • the conjugated heterocyclic aromatic di-nitrogen compounds are selected from dipyridyls, dipyridyl ethylenes, dipyridyl phenylenes, phenanthrolines, and diazafluorenes, wherein the nitrogen atoms are in a different aromatic ring and are able to form an onium salt. It is understood that all isomers of said conjugated heterocyclic aromatic di-nitrogen compounds in which both nitrogens can be substituted are useful in this invention.
  • the quencher may be one of the bis-onium salts derived from 3,3 '-dipyridyl, 4,4'-dipyridyl and 4,7-phenanthroline.
  • the viologen-boronic acid adduct may be a discrete compound having a molecular weight of about 400 Daltons or greater. In other embodiments, it may also be a pendant group or a chain unit of a water-soluble or water-dispersible polymer with a molecular weight greater than about 10,000 Daltons.
  • the quencher- polymer unit may be non-covalently associated with a polymer matrix and is physically immobilized therein. In yet another embodiment, the quencher-polymer unit may be immobilized as a complex with a negatively charge water-soluble polymer.
  • the viologen-boronic acid moiety may be a pendant group or a chain unit in a crosslinked, hydrophilic polymer or hydrogel sufficiently permeable to the analyte (e.g., glucose) to allow equilibrium to be established.
  • analyte e.g., glucose
  • the quencher may be covalently bonded to a second water-insoluble polymer matrix M 2 , which can be represented by the structure M 2 -L 2 -Q.
  • L 2 is a linker selected from the group consisting of a lower alkylene (e.g., C]-C 8 alkylene), sulfonamide, amide, quaternary ammonium, pyridinium, ester, ether, sulfide, sulfone, phenylene, urea, thiourea, urethane, amine, and a combination thereof.
  • the quencher may be linked to M 2 at one or two sites in some embodiments.
  • polymeric quencher precursors multiple options are available for attaching the boronic acid moiety and a reactive group which may be a polymerizable group or a coupling group to two different nitrogens in the heteroaromatic centrally located group. These are:
  • a reactive group on a first aromatic moiety is attached to one nitrogen and a second aromatic group containing at least one -B(OH)2 group is attached to the second nitrogen;
  • one or more boronic acid groups are attached to a first aromatic moiety which is attached to one nitrogen and one boronic acid and a reactive group are attached to a second aromatic group which second aromatic group is attached to the second nitrogen;
  • one boronic acid group and a reactive group are attached to a first aromatic moiety which first aromatic group is attached to one nitrogen, and a boronic acid group and a reactive group are attached to a second aromatic moiety which is attached to the second nitrogen;
  • one boronic acid is attached to each nitrogen and a reactive group is attached to the heteroaromatic ring.
  • Preferred embodiments comprise two boronic acid moieties and one polymerizable group or coupling group wherein the aromatic group is a benzyl substituent bonded to the nitrogen and the boronic acid groups are attached to the benzyl ring and may be in the ortho- meta or para- positions.
  • the boronic acid substituted viologen as a discrete compound useful for in vitro sensing may be represented by one of the following formulas:
  • n 1-3
  • X is halogen
  • Y 1 and Y 2 are independently selected from phenyl boronic acid (o- m- or p-isomers) and naphthyl boronic acid.
  • the quencher may comprise a boronic acid group as a substituent on the heterocyclic ring of a viologen.
  • a specific example used with TSPP is m-BBV:
  • the quencher precursors suitable for making sensors may be selected from the following:
  • the quencher precursor 3,3'-oBBV may be used with HPTS-LysMA or HPTS-CysMA to make hydrogels in accordance with preferred aspects of the invention.
  • Preferred quenchers are prepared from precursors comprising viologens derived from 3,3'-dipyridyl substituted on the nitrogens with benzylboronic acid groups and at other positions on the dipyridyl rings with a polymerizable group or a coupling group.
  • Representative viologens include:
  • L is LI or L2 and is a linking group
  • Z is a reactive group
  • R' is— B(OH) 2 in the ortho- meta- or para- positions on the benzyl ring and R" is H- ; or optionally R" is a coupling group as is defined herein or a substituent specifically used to modify the acidity of the boronic acid such as fluoro- or methoxy-
  • L is a divalent moiety that covalently connects the sensing moiety to a reactive group that is used to bind the viologen to a polymer or matrix.
  • Z is either a polymerizable ethylenically unsaturated group selected from but not limited to methacrylamido-, acrylamido-, methacryloyl-, acryloyl-, or styryl- or optionally Z is a reactive functional group, capable of forming a covalent bond with a polymer or matrix.
  • groups include but are not limited to -Br, -OH, -SH, -C0 2 H, and -NH 2 .
  • poly viologen includes: a discrete compound comprised of two or more viologens covalently bonded together by a linking group, a polymer comprised of viologen repeat units in the chain, a polymer with viologen groups pendant to the chain, a dendrimer comprised of viologen units, preferably including viologen terminal groups, an oligomer comprised of viologen units, preferably including viologen endgroups, and combinations thereof. Polymers in which mono-viologen groups form a minor component are not included.
  • the preferred quenchers are water soluble or dispersible polymers, or crosslinked, hydrophilic polymers or hydrogels sufficiently permeable to glucose to function as part of a sensor.
  • the polyviologen boronic acid may be directly bonded to an inert substrate.
  • a polyviologen quencher as a polymer comprised of viologen repeat units has the formula:
  • the polyviologen boronic acid adducts are formed by covalently linking two or more viologen/boronic acid intermediates.
  • the bridging group is typically a small divalent radical bonded to one nitrogen in each viologen, or to a carbon in the aromatic ring of each viologen, or one bond may be to a ring carbon in one viologen and to a nitrogen in the other.
  • Two or more boronic acid groups are attached to the polyviologen.
  • the polyviologen boronic acid adduct is substituted with a polymerizable group or coupling group attached directly to the viologen or to the bridging group.
  • the polyviologen moiety includes only one such group.
  • the bridging group is selected to enhance cooperative binding of the boronic acids to glucose.
  • the coupling moiety is a linking group as defined previously with the proviso that the linking group is optionally further substituted with a boronic acid, a polymerizable group, an additional coupling group, or is a segment in a polymer chain in which the viologen is a chain unit, a pendant group, or any combination thereof.
  • the indicator system comprising some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein may include an immobilizing medium whose presence may prevent some of the fiuorophores and/or some of the binding moieties from freely diffusing through the sample.
  • the immobilizing medium may limit the mobility of the sensing moieties (including one or more types of fluorophores and one or more types of binding moieties) such that they remain physically close enough to one another to react (quenching).
  • the immobilizing medium is preferably insoluble in an aqueous environment (e.g., intravascular), permeable to the target analytes, and impermeable to the sensing moieties.
  • the immobilizing medium is preferably insoluble in the sample's solvent, permeable to the target analytes, and, again, impermeable to the sensing moieties.
  • a bench top glucose meter for measuring glucose activity in aqueous solution may comprise a water-insoluble organic polymer matrix that is permeable to the target analytes and impermeable to the sensing moieties.
  • the HPTS-triLysMA dye and 3,3'-oBBV quencher may be effectively immobilized within a DMAA ( ⁇ , ⁇ -dimethylacrylamide) hydrogel matrix (described in detail below).
  • DMAA ⁇ , ⁇ -dimethylacrylamide
  • the sensing moieties may be used as individual (discrete) components.
  • the concentration of analyte in a liquid sample may be measured by adding and mixing into the sample the one or more types of fluorophores and binding moieties, exciting the one or more types of fluorophores with light of the appropriate wavelengths, and detecting the intensity of the fluorescence emitted by the fluorophores. Analyte concentration may then be calculated from the measured intensity. Afterwards, the sample has been contaminated with the one or more fluorophores and binding moieties and may need to be discarded. Of course, if the sample is taken from a larger solution, the amount of discarded solution may be insignificant.
  • polymeric matrices may be used to trap the sensing moieties so that the sensing moieties do not permanently contaminate the sample, and so that the sensing moieties may be reused to determine analyte concentration in another sample.
  • the sensing moieties may be immobilized allowing their use to measure analytes in a moving stream.
  • some embodiments of the indicator system may be used in a moving stream of physiological fluid which contains one or more analytes, such as polyhydroxyl organic compounds, whose concentration is to be measured.
  • Other embodiments for in vivo applications may be implanted in tissue such as muscle which contains the aforementioned analytes.
  • the sensing moieties do not escape from the sensor assembly. In some embodiments, this is accomplished by making the sensing moieties a part of an organic polymer sensing assembly. Soluble fluorophores and binding moieties may be confined by a semi-permeable membrane that allows passage of the analyte but blocks passage of the sensing moieties.
  • sensing moieties soluble molecules that are substantially larger than the analyte molecules (molecular weight of at least twice that of the analyte or greater than 1000 preferably greater than 5000); and employing a selective semipermeable membrane such as a dialysis or an ultrafiltration membrane with a specific molecular weight cutoff between the two so that the sensing moieties are quantitatively retained.
  • a selective semipermeable membrane such as a dialysis or an ultrafiltration membrane with a specific molecular weight cutoff between the two so that the sensing moieties are quantitatively retained.
  • the glucose sensing moieties may be immobilized in an insoluble polymer matrix, which is freely permeable to glucose.
  • the polymer matrix may include of organic, inorganic or combinations of polymers thereof.
  • the matrix may be composed of biocompatible materials.
  • the matrix may be coated with a second biocompatible polymer that is permeable to the analytes of interest.
  • biocompatible materials may not be necessary or even advantageous.
  • the function of the polymer matrix is to hold together and immobilize the one or more fluorophores and one or more binding moieties while at the same time allowing contact and binding between the analyte and the one or more binding moieties.
  • the matrix must be insoluble in the solution containing the analyte, but also be in close association with it through the establishment of a high surface area interface between matrix and analyte solution.
  • an ultra-thin film or microporous support matrix may be used.
  • the matrix may be swellable in the analyte solution.
  • a hydrogel matrix may be used.
  • the sensing polymers are bonded to a surface such as the surface of a light conduit, or impregnated in a microporous membrane.
  • the matrix does not substantially interfere with transport of the analyte to the binding sites so that equilibrium may be established between the two phases.
  • Techniques for preparing ultra-thin films, microporous polymers, microporous sol-gels, and hydrogels are established in the art. Useful matrices are typically substantially permeable to the analyte being examined.
  • Hydrogel polymers are used in some embodiments.
  • hydrogel refers to a polymer that swells substantially, but does not dissolve in water.
  • Such hydrogels may be linear, branched, or network polymers, or polyelectrolyte complexes, with the proviso that they contain no soluble or leachable fractions.
  • hydrogel networks are prepared by a crosslinking step, which is performed on water-soluble polymers so that they swell but do not dissolve in aqueous media.
  • the hydrogel polymers are prepared by copolymerizing a mixture of hydrophilic and crosslinking monomers to obtain a water swellable network polymer.
  • Such polymers are formed either by addition or condensation polymerization, or by combination process.
  • the one or more fluorophores and one or more binding moieties may be incorporated into the polymer by copolymerization using monomeric derivatives in combination with network-forming monomers.
  • the one or more fluorophores and one or more binding moieties may be coupled to an already prepared matrix using a post polymerization reaction.
  • the one or more fluorophores and one or more binding moieties can be viewed as units in the polymer chain, or as pendant groups attached to the chain.
  • the hydrogels useful in this invention are also monolithic polymers, such as a single network to which both sensing moieties are covalently bonded, or as multi-component hydrogels.
  • Multi-component hydrogels include interpenetrating networks, polyelectrolyte complexes, and various other blends of two or more polymers to obtain a water swellable composite, which includes dispersions of a second polymer in a hydrogel matrix and alternating microlayer assemblies.
  • Monolithic hydrogels are typically formed by free radical copolymerization of a mixture of hydrophilic monomers, including but not limited to HEMA, PEGMA, methacrylic acid, hydroxyethyl acrylate, N-vinyl pyrrolidone, acrylamide, ⁇ , ⁇ '-dimethyl acrylamide, and the like; ionic monomers include methacryloylaminopropyl trimethylammonium chloride, diallyl dimethyl ammonium, chloride, vinyl benzyl trimethyl ammonium chloride, sodium sulfopropyl methacrylate, and the like; crosslinkers include ethylene dimethacrylate, PEGDMA, trimethylolpropane triacrylate, and the like.
  • hydrophilic monomers including but not limited to HEMA, PEGMA, methacrylic acid, hydroxyethyl acrylate, N-vinyl pyrrolidone, acrylamide, ⁇ , ⁇ '-dimethyl acrylamide, and the
  • the ratios of monomers are chosen to optimize network properties including permeability, swelling index, and gel strength using principles well established in the art.
  • the fluorophore is derived from an ethylenically unsaturated derivative of a dye molecule, such as 8-acetoxypyrene-l,3,6-N, N', N"- tris(methacrylamidopropylsulfonamide), the binding moiety is derived from an ethylenically unsaturated viologen such as 4-N-(benzyl-3-boronic acid)-4'-N'-(benzyl-4ethenyl)-dipyridinium dihalide (m-SBBV) and the matrix is made from HEMA and PEGDMA.
  • the concentration of fluorophore is chosen to optimize emission intensity.
  • the ratio of binding moiety to fluorophore is adjusted to provide sufficient binding to produce the desired measurable signal.
  • a monolithic hydrogel is formed by a condensation polymerization.
  • acetoxy pyrene trisulfonyl chloride is reacted with an excess of PEG diamine to obtain a tris-(amino PEG) adduct dissolved in the unreacted diamine.
  • a solution of excess trimesoyl chloride and an acid acceptor is reacted with 4-N-(benzyl-3-boronic acid)-4'- N'-(2 hydroxyethyl) bipyridinium dihalide to obtain an acid chloride functional ester of the viologen.
  • the two reactive mixtures are brought into contact with each other and allowed to react to form the hydrogel, e.g. by casting a thin film of one mixture and dipping it into the other.
  • multi-component hydrogels wherein the fluorophore is incorporated in one component and the binding moiety in another are preferred for making the sensor of this invention.
  • these systems are optionally molecularly imprinted to enhance interaction between components and to provide selectivity for glucose over other polyhydroxy analytes.
  • the multicomponent system is an interpenetrating polymer network (IPN) or a semi-interpenetrating polymer network (semi-IPN).
  • the IPN polymers are typically made by sequential polymerization. First, a network comprising the binding moiety is formed. The network is then swollen with a mixture of monomers including the fluorophore monomer and a second polymerization is carried out to obtain the IPN hydrogel.
  • the semi-IPN hydrogel is formed by dissolving a soluble polymer containing a fluorophore in a mixture of monomers including a binding moiety monomer and polymerizing the mixture.
  • the sensing components are immobilized by an insoluble polymer matrix which is freely permeable to polyhydroxyl compounds. Additional details on hydrogel systems have been disclosed in US Patent Publications Nos. US2004/0028612, and 2006/0083688 which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entireties.
  • the polymer matrix is comprised of organic, inorganic or combinations of polymers thereof.
  • the matrix may be composed of biocompatible materials.
  • the matrix is coated with a second biocompatible polymer that is permeable to the analytes of interest.
  • the function of the polymer matrix is to hold together and immobilize the fluorophore and binding moieties while at the same time allowing contact with the analytes (e.g., polyhydroxyl compounds, H + and OH " ), and binding of the polyhydroxyl compounds to the boronic acid. Therefore, the matrix is insoluble in the medium and in close association with it by establishing a high surface area interface between matrix and analyte solution.
  • the matrix also does not interfere with transport of the analyte to the binding sites so that equilibrium can be established between the two phases.
  • an ultra-thin film or microporous support matrix may be used.
  • the matrix that is swellable in the analyte solution e.g. a hydrogel matrix
  • the sensing polymers are bonded to a surface such as the surface of a light conduit, or impregnated in a microporous membrane. Techniques for preparing ultra-thin films, microporous polymers, microporous sol-gels, and hydrogels have been established in the prior art.
  • the boronic acid substituted viologen may be covalently bonded to a fluorophore.
  • the adduct may be a polymerizable compound or a unit in a polymer.
  • One such adduct for example may be prepared by first forming an unsymmetrical viologen from 4,4'-dipyridyl by attaching a benzyl-3-boronic acid group to one nitrogen and an aminoethyl group to the other nitrogen atom.
  • the viologen is condensed sequentially first with 8-acetoxy-pyrene-l,3,6-trisulfonyl chloride in a 1 :1 mole ratio followed by reaction with excess PEG diamine to obtain a prepolymer mixture.
  • An acid acceptor is included in both steps to scavenge the byproduct acid.
  • the prepolymer mixture is crosslinked by reaction with a polyisocyanate to obtain a hydrogel.
  • the product is treated with base to remove the acetoxy blocking group. Incomplete reaction products and unreacted starting materials are leached out of the hydrogel by exhaustive extraction with deionized water before further use.
  • the product is responsive to glucose when used as the sensing component as described herein.
  • such adducts are ethylenically unsaturated monomer derivatives.
  • dimethyl bis-bromomethyl benzene boronate is reacted with excess 4,4'-dipyridyl to form a half viologen adduct.
  • the adduct is further reacted with an excess of bromoethylamine hydrochloride to form the bis-viologen adduct.
  • This adduct is coupled to a pyranine dye by reaction with the 8-acetoxypyrene-tris sulfonyl chloride in a 1 :1 mole ratio in the presence of an acid acceptor followed by reaction with excess aminopropylmethacrylamide. Finally, any residual amino groups may be reacted with methacrylol chloride. After purification, the dye/viologen monomer may be copolymerized with HEMA and PEGDMA to obtain a hydrogel.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,1 14,676 (incorporated by reference herein in its entirety) provides a fluorescent indicator which may be covalently attached to a particle or to a macrocrystalline cellulose fiber.
  • a sensor utilizing the indicator may comprise an optically transparent substrate, a thermoplastic layer and a hydrogel. Part of the particle with the indicator attached thereto is imbedded in a thermoplastic layer that is coated on the substrate and mechanically adhered using heat and pressure. The majority of the particle/indicator is imbedded within a hydrogel layer that is applied over the thermoplastic layer.
  • Such a sensor may be applied to the tip of an optical waveguide.
  • the dye can be measured with relatively inexpensive instrumentation that combines UV and blue LEDs and a photodiode module.
  • the preferred sensing device comprises at least one light source, a detector, and a sensor comprising a fluorescent reporter dye system.
  • the fluorescent reporter dye system comprises a fluorescent dye operably coupled to an analyte-binding quencher.
  • the dye may be covalently bound to the quencher or merely associated with the quencher.
  • the dye and quencher are preferably operably coupled, which means that in operation, the quencher is in close enough proximity to the dye to interact with and modulate its fluorescence.
  • the dye and quencher may be constrained together within an analyte-permeable hydrogel or other polymeric matrix.
  • the fluorescent dye When excited by light of appropriate wavelength, the fluorescent dye emits light (e.g., fluoresces). The intensity of the light is dependent on the extent of quenching which varies with the amount of analyte binding.
  • the fluorescent dye and the quencher may be covalently attached to hydrogel or other polymeric matrix, instead of to one another.
  • the sensor probe 200 of the measurement device includes a protective housing 500 which provides protection to the indicator system 307.
  • the protective housing 500 may further protect the immobilizing medium.
  • the protective housing 500 may be appropriately sized for in vitro bench top laboratory use.
  • a protective housing 500 may provide a protective benefit to a sensor probe 200 that is designed for in vivo analyte measurement, and in some embodiments, more specifically, for a sensor probe 200 that is designed for intravascular analyte measurement.
  • the protective housing 500 may be constructed of physiologically compatible materials and may be sized for intravascular deployment.
  • the temperature sensing element may be contained within the protective housing 500.
  • the protective housing 500 may be constructed of a hollow tube comprising a first material 501, and a second material 502 coating the first material 501.
  • the second material 502 may coat the first material 501 so as to form a continuous substantially impermeable outer wall of the hollow tube, except in a region where a portion of the second material 502 has been selectively removed in order to generate at least one opening in the outer wall, while retaining the first material 501 in that region.
  • the first material 501 may form a tubular mesh 501 A.
  • the first material 501 may form a coil 501B.
  • the first material 501 (whether in the form of a tubular mesh 501A or a coil 501B) is visible in the figures through the cutouts 503 in outer wall formed by the second material 502.
  • Examples of materials suitable for use as the coil or tubular mesh include both metallic and non-metallic materials.
  • Suitable metallic materials include stainless steel, gold, titanium and silver, and alloys such as nitinol, beryllium copper and MP-35-N alloys comprising cobalt, nickel, chromium, and molybdenum. In some embodiments, stainless steel is preferred.
  • Suitable non-metallic materials include synthetic polymers such as polyamides, polyesters, polyurethanes, polyolefins, nylon and fiuoropolymers, for example polytetrafluoroethylene (PTFE).
  • the first material 501 must, however, be chosen so that it is possible to selectively remove a region of the second material 502 which coats the first material, without the first material itself being removed in that region.
  • the first material 501 can be in the form of a coil 501B, see Figure 7B, or a tubular mesh 501 A, see Figure 7A.
  • the coil can be made from wires of the first material 501 which preferably have either a round or flat cross-section.
  • the mesh structure advantageously comprises a number of filaments.
  • filament is used to refer to any elongated strand irrespective of its cross-sectional configuration and structure.
  • the filaments may be round or flat in cross-section.
  • the mesh can comprise a number of helically wound filaments, for example comprising a first group of filaments wound in an anticlockwise direction and a second group of filaments wound in an opposite, clockwise direction.
  • the tubular mesh 501A of Figure 7A displays this configuration. Suitable mesh structures are described in International publication No. WO/2004/054438 which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety.
  • the density of filament crossovers may be varied in order to control the properties of the resulting hollow tube.
  • a high density mesh may engender the hollow tube with greater strength while a low density mesh provide the hollow tube with greater flexibility. Variation in the tightness of a coil can provide a similar effect.
  • Variation in mesh density and/or coil tightness may also vary the porosity of the mesh. This variation may be significant at the location of the opening in the outer wall formed by the second material since the porosity of the mesh in this region will control the speed of diffusion of the analyte into the sensor. Porosity is also important for embodiments employing an immobilizing medium because, in certain such embodiments, the mesh may need to be sufficiently dense (or the coil winding sufficiently tight) to prevent seepage or leakage of the immobilizing medium out of the sensor's protective housing.
  • coil tightness and/or mesh density must be chosen simultaneously to give the protective housing sufficient strength and flexibility to protect against impacts and abrasions, to allow sufficient diffusion of analytes into the protective housing, and to contain the immobilizing medium so that it does not leak out of the protective housing.
  • leakage of an immobilizing medium out of the protective housing need not be considered.
  • Suitable materials for use as the second material generally include polymeric materials.
  • polymeric materials include polyesters, polyolefins such as polyethylene (PE), e.g. low density polyethylene (LDPE), fluoropolymers such as fluorinated ethylene propylene (FEP), polytetrafluoroethylene (PTFE) and perfluoroalkoxy polymer (PFA), polyvinylchloride (PVC), polyamides such as polyether block amide (PEBA), Pebax®, nylon and polyurethane.
  • PETs and polyolefins are preferred due to their suitability for extrusion over the coil or tubular mesh. The selective removal of a portion of a polyester or polyolefin coating, e.g. by laser ablation, is also straightforward. Polyolefins are particularly preferred due to the ease of laser ablating these materials.
  • the second material is first used to coat the coil or tubular mesh formed by the first material.
  • the second material can either coat the outer surfaces of the first material, and in effect form a continuous substantially impermeable tube around the coil or tubular mesh formed by the first material, or the second material can entirely encapsulate the first material, effectively forming a tube of the second material in which is embedded the coil or tubular mesh formed by the first material.
  • the second material can be applied to the first material by dip coating the coil or tubular mesh formed by the first material.
  • the second material may be a polyamide, which results in a very stiff tube.
  • a tube of the second material can be provided, around which is formed the coil or tubular mesh of the first material. A further layer of the second material is then applied over the first material, resulting in the first material being sandwiched between two layers of the second material.
  • the second material is different from the first material.
  • “different from” means that the first and second materials have some difference in physical properties such that it is possible to selectively remove a region of the second material. This difference may be achieved by using an entirely different material, or by using the same material but using different forms which have different physical properties.
  • the first material is metallic and the second material is polymeric.
  • radio opaque additives such as barium sulfate, bismuth subcarbonate, bismuth trioxide and tungsten can be added. Where present, these are preferably doped within the second material.
  • a portion of the second material is selectively removed in order to generate at least one opening in a region of the outer wall of the protective housing, while retaining the first material in that region.
  • the first material is present in the form of a coil or a tubular mesh, the first material does not form a completely closed tube. Accordingly, when the second material is removed in said region, this effectively forms a break in the continuous substantially impermeable wall of the tube.
  • the second material simply coats the first material, it is necessary simply to remove the coating provided by this second material in the region where the opening is to be formed.
  • the second material effectively encapsulates the first material, it is necessary to remove all of the second material which surrounds and encapsulates the first material in the region of the protective housing where the opening is to be formed.
  • the indicator system 307 used to generate a signal indicative of the concentration of the analyte of interest is located adjacent to the opening 503 formed by selective removal of the second material. This allows the indicator system to measure analyte concentration near the region of the opening in the wall of the tube.
  • the environment of the fluid in this region is substantially similar to the environment of the fluid further away from the sensor probe's protective housing 500, and therefore the analyte concentration determined in this region will likely accurately represent the analyte concentration elsewhere in the fluid.
  • the sensor probe 200 and protective housing 500 may be inserted into a blood vessel, for example, and glucose in the blood will preferably migrate through the opening in the second material, and into the hollow tube, where its concentration can be determined by the indicator system in conjunction with the other components of the measurement device.
  • the measurement device is a bench top glucose meter
  • the sensor probe 200 and protective housing 500 may be dipped into a solution contained in a beaker or test tube, for example, such that the opening in the second material is submerged. The solution will then pass through the opening in the second material, into the hollow tube, and the glucose concentration of the solution may be determined by the indicator system in conjunction with the other components of the glucose sensor.
  • the size of the opening in the second material will generally be between 1 and 400 mm 2 , for example between 25 and 225 mm 2 .
  • the size of the opening is preferably not too small or the solution into which the sensor is introduced will not be able to pass through the opening or will pass through in insufficient quantities for an accurate measurement to be made.
  • the opening is preferably not to large or else the immobilizing medium constraining the free diffusion of the sensing moieties may be able to seep out. In some embodiments, it is advantageous that the opening be large enough to allow positioning of the indicator system such that it is adjacent to the opening.
  • the second material forming the outer wall of the protective housing 500 possesses only a single opening 503 allowing passing of the analyte.
  • a plurality of openings 503 may be generated in the outer wall of the protective housing 500— i.e. more than one region of the second material has been removed.
  • the protective housings 500 of the sensor probes 200 displayed in Figures 7A and 7B each possess three regions where the second material 502 has been removed, exposing the first material 501A, 501B, and creating three openings 503 for the passage of analytes.
  • configurations of multiple openings in the protective housing allow for indicator systems, or portions of indicator systems, to be located at a number of points along the length of the protective housing, and for multiple measurements to be taken.
  • a number of indicator systems it is possible for a number of indicator systems to be located within a single protective housing, each measuring the analyte in a portion of the fluid containing the analyte which enters the protective housing through a different opening in the housing.
  • a single indicator system may comprise multiple sub-systems, each of which is spatially separated within the protective housing, and each of which measures the analyte in a portion of the fluid containing the analyte which enters the protective housing through a different opening in the housing.
  • protective housings 500 may, in many instances, provide a robust and durable enclosure for protecting the sensitive components of the sensor probe 200.
  • Such protective housings may protect an in vitro sensor probe from impacts and abrasions occurring during bench top laboratory use.
  • such protective housings may provide the durability and maneuverability necessary for intravascular use.
  • many types of protective housings may be suitable for protecting the indicator systems disclosed herein, beyond those particular types of protective housings that have been disclosed above.
  • Some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein generate a signal indicative of analyte concentration which exhibits a temperature dependence. For example, if two solutions of precisely the same analyte concentration are measured at two different temperatures with the same measurement device, in some embodiments, the measurement device may generate differing signals indicative of the two analyte concentrations. Thus, the accuracy of determining a solution's true analyte concentration based on such as signal may be improved by taking the temperature of the solution into account.
  • [Glu] is the estimated glucose concentration
  • a T is the first Michaelis-Menten parameter "a”, at a temperature T
  • b T is the second Michaelis-Menten parameter "b”, at the same temperature T
  • c T is the third Michaelis-Menten parameter "c”, at the same temperature T
  • Various embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein employ a quencher-fluorophore indicator system which measures analyte concentration through the establishment of an equilibrium between the analyte of interest, the binding moiety (e.g. quencher), and the fluorophore.
  • analyte concentration is not measured by enzymatic consumption or conversion of the analyte.
  • the classic Michaelis-Menten equation specifically describes enzyme kinetics, a non- equilibrium phenomena involving the consumption/conversion of the enzyme's substrate by the enzyme.
  • some embodiment methods of estimating an analyte concentration include generating a signal indicative of analyte concentration and a signal indicative of temperature. Since, in some embodiments, the signal indicative of analyte concentration exhibits the temperature dependence just described, in some embodiments, the signal indicative of temperature may be used to adjust the signal indicative of analyte concentration to correct for temperature dependence.
  • the methods further include transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation, such as Equation 1 above, depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, such as the parameters "a", "b", and "c", as described above with reference to Equation 1.
  • Equation 1 The temperature dependence of Equation 1 is exhibited through the Michaelis- Menten parameters ⁇ , br, and cr, as indicated by the subscript "I" labeling these parameters.
  • the temperature dependence may need to be determined through a temperature calibration.
  • the values of one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based on data which includes temperature calibration data and the signal indicative of a temperature.
  • the temperature calibration data may be generated by a temperature calibration method.
  • the temperature calibration method may include selecting a first test analyte sensing element, and creating and/or providing a set of at least three solutions of differing known analyte concentrations.
  • a first temperature is selected (77), three solutions of the set of at least three solutions are heated and/or cooled to a temperature substantially similar to the selected first temperature, and a first set of at least three signals is generated using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different one of the three solutions at the first temperature. Measurements are then made at a second temperature.
  • a second temperature is selected (72), three solutions of the set of at least three solutions (each of the three may be the same or different than a solution chosen for the first temperature) are heated and/or cooled to a temperature substantially similar to the selected second temperature, and a second set of at least three signals is generated using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different one of the three solutions at the second temperature.
  • more than three solutions may be used in either of these steps.
  • more than two temperatures may also be employed. Generally, the more solutions of differing concentration and the greater number of different temperatures that are employed, the greater the accuracy of the resulting calibration data.
  • the sets of signals are used to determine (usually approximately) the relationship between one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters and temperature.
  • the temperature calibration method may further include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (a T i, bn, and c T i) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a first fit dataset comprising the first set of at least three signals.
  • the temperature calibration method may further include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature ( ⁇ 3 ⁇ 4, bn, and cn) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a second fit dataset comprising the second set of at least three signals.
  • each of the three Michaelis- Menten parameters has been determined at least two temperatures, providing data which may be used to create a model of the temperature dependence of each of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters.
  • the temperature calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the first Michaelis-Menten parameter (a T ) to temperature, the equation depending on a first set of temperature calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the first set of calibration parameters based on the value of the first Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature ( n) and the value of the first Michaelis- Menten parameter at the second temperature (aji)-
  • similar steps are performed with respect to the second and third Michaelis-Menten parameters (b T and ci).
  • the temperature calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the second Michaelis-Menten parameter (b T ) to temperature, the equation depending on a second set of temperature calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the second set of calibration parameters based on the value of the second Michaelis- Menten parameter at the first temperature (bri) and the value of the second Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature (fe)-
  • the temperature calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the third Michaelis-Menten parameter (c ) to temperature, the equation depending on a third set of temperature calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the third set of calibration parameters based on the value of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (en) and the value of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature ( ⁇ 3 ⁇ 4).
  • equations linear in temperature may be selected to relate the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters to temperature.
  • the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters may be written as
  • each Michaelis-Menten parameter a T , br, and CT is determined by multiplying the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameterI37, sT, and C37, by its corresponding "temperature correction factor,” ⁇ ( ⁇ ), ⁇ (r), or ⁇ ( ⁇ ), respectively.
  • the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters may be determined by fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a set of signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a plurality of solutions of differing analyte concentrations held at a temperature of 37 °C, as described above with respect to, for example, 77 and 12.
  • the parameters a 37 , b ⁇ , and C37 may be supplied by a factory calibration as described in provisional U.S. patent application No. 61/184,747, "Algorithms for Calibrating an Analyte Sensor," filed June 5, 2009, which is hereby incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • 037, b3 7 , and C37 may be determine via a one-point in vivo calibration as also disclosed in the same application.
  • T (r) some embodiment methods may employ a linear approximation.
  • the temperature correction factors may be written as
  • TempCos temperature calibration coefficients
  • a temperature calibration method used to determine values of these TempCos may require that values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters be determined at a second temperature (T2), different than 37 °C. Values of the parameters at the second temperature ⁇ an, br 2 , and cj ) may be determined by fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a set of signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a plurality of solutions of differing analyte concentrations held at the second temperature, as described above with respect to, for example, Tl and T2.
  • the temperature calibration coefficients m a and b a may be determined by normalizing to 037 both ⁇ 2 and 037, yielding «72/ 037 and 1, and fitting a line to the normalized values versus the two temperatures, T2 and 37 °C.
  • the fit may be determined using linear least squares or any other method of fitting a line to a set of points.
  • the temperature calibration coefficient m aT is set equal to the slope of the resulting line and the temperature calibration coefficient ⁇ is set equal to the intercept.
  • the other temperature calibration coefficients, m and ⁇ , may be determined similarly from values of br 2 and bn, and m CT and ⁇ may be determined from values of 3 ⁇ 4 and ⁇ 3 ⁇ 4 7 .
  • a temperature corrected estimated glucose concentration may be computed from a fluorescent signal ( , ) measured at temperature (7), by using the TempCos ( m ar , ⁇ ⁇ , m ⁇ , ⁇ , m CT , and ⁇ ), the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters 37 °C (a 37 , bn, and C37), and the temperature (7) in Equations 2 and 3 to compute ⁇ , br, and cj, and then plugging ⁇ , br, cj and the measured fluorescent signal ( G, ) into Equation 1.
  • the first, second, and third sets of temperature calibration parameters may include a slope and an intercept relating temperature to the value of either the first, second, or third Michaelis-Menten parameter.
  • equations of other forms may be selected to relate the first, second, or third Michaelis-Menten equation to temperature.
  • a quadratic or higher-order polynomial in temperature may be suitable and/or desirable.
  • each measurement device When measurement devices are mass produced, it may not be feasible or practical to individually calibrate each measurement device— i.e. use each individual measurement device to generate individual calibration data. It may be more cost effective to select one or more test devices from a batch of mass produced devices, generate calibration data using the one or more test devices, and provide that calibration data to each individual devices produced in the batch.
  • variability between measurement devices from the same production batch may be, to a large extent, attributable to a particular part of the measurement device.
  • variability between devices may be attributable to the part of the measurement device which generates a signal indicative of analyte concentration— e.g.
  • the analyte sensing element and/or the part of the measurement device that generates a signal indicative of temperature— e.g. the temperature sensing element.
  • the calibration method may further include selecting a second test analyte sensing element; generating a third set of at least three signals using the second test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of known analyte concentration at the first temperature (77); and generating a fourth set of at least three signals using the second test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of known analyte concentration at the second temperature (72).
  • calibration methods may similarly employ more than two test devices, or more particularly, for instance, more than two test analyte sensing elements.
  • the sets of signals are used to determine (usually approximately) the relationship between one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters and temperature.
  • the temperature calibration method may further include (1) computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (an, bn, and en) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a first fit dataset comprising both the first set of at least three signals (which was generated with the first test analyte sensing element at Tl) and the third set of at least three signals (which was generated with the second test analyte sensing element at 77); and (2) computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature an, b , and cn) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a second fit dataset comprising both the second set of at least three signals (which was generated with the first test analyte sensing element at 72) and fourth set of at least three signals (which was generated with the second test analyte sensing element at 72).
  • the signals generated with the second test analyte sensing element are used in a combined fit with the signals generated with the first test analyte sensing element, which results in values for each of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters which take both test analyte sensing elements into account.
  • a temperature calibration method may take both test analyte sensing elements into account by fitting the signals generated from each test analyte sensing element separately, and then averaging the results to obtain better estimates of the Michaelis-Menten parameters.
  • the step of computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (a T i, b T i, and en) by an algorithm may further include fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a third fit dataset comprising the third set of at least three signals, and averaging the results of fitting the third fit dataset with the results of fitting the first fit dataset.
  • the step of computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature ( ⁇ 3 ⁇ 4, b T 2, and c T i) by an algorithm may further include fitting a modified Michaelis- Menten equation to a fourth fit dataset comprising the fourth set of at least three signals, and averaging the results of fitting the fourth fit dataset with the results of fitting the second fit dataset.
  • a method of estimating an analyte concentration from a signal indicative of the analyte concentration may include transforming the signal using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein the values of one or more Michaelis-Menten parameters have been adjusted for temperature.
  • a method of estimating an analyte concentration may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration and generating a signal indicative of a temperature, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more temperature calibration parameters and the signal indicative of temperature.
  • a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more temperature calibration parameters and the signal indicative of temperature.
  • the step of transforming the signal indicative of analyte concentration may utilize a "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation in which each of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters have been substituted with first, second, and third calibration equations (respectively), each of the equations depending on sets of first, second, and third temperature calibration parameters (respectively), and each also depending on the signal indicative of temperature.
  • at least one of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a polynomial in the signal indicative of temperature.
  • each of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a polynomial in the signal indicative of temperature. In certain embodiments, at least one of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a linear equation in the signal indicative of temperature. In certain such embodiments, each of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a linear equation in the signal indicative of temperature.
  • [Glu] is the estimated glucose concentration
  • each set of temperature calibration parameters may be determined by fitting the "substituted" modified Michaelis- Menten equation to a plurality of signals, the plurality of signals indicative of analyte concentration in a plurality of solutions at a plurality of temperatures. Once values of the various temperature calibration parameters are determined, temperature corrected estimates of analyte concentrations may be generated from signals indicative of analyte concentration and temperature.
  • This example concerns the temperature calibration of an equilibrium fluorescence glucose sensor— referred to herein as a GluCath sensor— employing an HPTS-Cys- MA dye operably coupled to a 3,3'-oBBV quencher.
  • the dye and quencher are immobilized within a hydrogel disposed along the distal region of an optical fiber, while the proximal end of the optical fiber is coupled to a light source.
  • the temperature dependence of this sensor's fluorescence response to glucose was assumed to be described by the modified Michaelis- Menten equation of Equation 1 as described above.
  • the Michaelis-Menten parameters were assumed to bear a linear relationship to temperature as set forth in Equations 2 and 3 above.
  • the TempCos m ar , ⁇ , m ⁇
  • Equations 2 and 3 the effect of temperature on the fluorescent signal was determined experimentally by measuring the signal at four temperatures (15 °C, 25 °C, 37 °C, and 45 °C) and four glucose concentrations (50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL). At each temperature and glucose level the stable signal, G 2 , was recorded.
  • Figure 8 displays four plots of fluorescent signal versus glucose concentration— one plot for each of these four temperatures.
  • Figure 9 displays the same data with each constant temperature plot normalized to the value of its fluorescent signal at 50 mg/dL.
  • Figure 10 displays essentially the same raw data as Figure 8, but instead displays four plots of fluorescent signal versus temperature— one plot for each of the four glucose concentrations. Apparent from Figure 10, is that the fluorescent signal's temperature dependence— at constant glucose concentration— is approximately linear.
  • values of ⁇ 3 ⁇ 45, b 2 s, and c 25 were determined by fitting Equation 1 to the fluorescence data generated at 25 °C; values of a 37 , bn, and c 37 were determined by fitting Equation 1 to the fluorescence data generated at 57 °C; and finally, values of a 4 s, b 4 $, and c 45 were determined by fitting Equation 1 to the fluorescence data generated at 45 °C.
  • Equation 2 An equation for computing a temperature corrected glucose concentration from a fluorescent signal and these temperature calibration parameters may be derived by substituting Equation 2 into Equation 1 which yields
  • Equation 3 further substituting for ⁇ ⁇ ( ⁇ ), r b (T), and T c (T) in Equation which yields
  • Example 2 This example also concerns the temperature calibration of an equilibrium fluorescence glucose GluCath sensor.
  • the GluCath sensor employs an HPTS-Cys-MA dye operably coupled to a 3,3'-oBBV quencher, with the dye and quencher immobilized within a hydrogel disposed along the distal region of an optical fiber, while the proximal end of the optical fiber is coupled to a light source.
  • the temperature dependence of this sensor's fluorescence response to glucose was assumed to be described by the modified Michaelis- Menten equation of Equation 1 as described above.
  • the Michaelis-Menten parameters were assumed to bear a linear relationship to temperature as set forth in Equations 2 and 3 above.
  • the TempCos, m , ⁇ ⁇ , , ⁇ , m Cr , and ⁇ were determined by the methodology described above in reference to
  • Equations 2 and 3 the effect of temperature on the fluorescent signal was determined experimentally by measuring the signal at four temperatures (15 °C, 25 °C, 37 °C, and 45 °C) and four glucose concentrations (50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL). At each temperature and glucose level the stable signal, G 2 , was recorded. The raw data from this experiment is plotted in Figure 11.
  • FIG. 12 plots glucose response— G 2 versus glucose concentration— for each of the four temperatures. This figure illustrates that the fluorescent signal G 2 is inversely related to temperature and also that there are large differences in the fluorescent signal G 2 at all glucose levels over the range of temperatures likely to be encountered in the intensive care unit— i.e. 15 °C to 45 °C.
  • the modified Michaelis-Menten equation (equation 1) was fit to the fluorescent signal G 2 versus glucose concentration to determine best-fit values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters ⁇ , br, and CT at each temperature.
  • the four best-fit modified Michaelis-Menten equations are overlaid on the data in Figure 12. The quality of the fits is evident from the figure.
  • Figure 13 plots each of a T , b T , and c T versus temperature, the values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters corresponding to the best-fits displayed in Figure 12.
  • the plots of each of a T , br, and CT versus temperature illustrate that, in some embodiments, best-fit values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters change approximately linearly with temperature.
  • the best-fit values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters at each temperature were normalized to their values at 37 °C and the normalized values were fit using linear regression to compute slopes and intercepts as shown in Figure 14.
  • the TempCos can then be used to predict the temperature dependent Michaelis-Menten parameters ⁇ , br, and c by multiplying the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters a 37 , bs7, and C37, by a temperature correction factor, ⁇ ( ⁇ ), ⁇ ( ⁇ ), or ⁇ (T), respectively, as indicated by Equation 3.
  • the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters a 37 , b 37 , and C37 may be measured at calibration, determined by a factory calibration, or potentially supplied by any other appropriate method.
  • TempCos were used to perform temperature correction on an independent data set, as illustrated in Figure 15.
  • the G 2 fluorescent signal versus plasma glucose concentration was measured at four reference plasma glucose levels (50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL) and at four temperatures (15 °C, 25 °C, 37 °C, and 45 °C).
  • the reference measurements of plasma glucose level are indicated as single points (small and medium sized circles) in Figure 15. Temperature measurements as determined by thermocouple are also displayed.
  • the other curve displayed in Figure 15 is the temperature corrected plasma glucose concentration.
  • the four reference plasma glucose levels at 37 °C (indicated by medium sized circles in Figure 15) were fit to a modified Michaelis-Menten equation (Equation 1, as previously described) to generate values of the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters ( ⁇ 3 ⁇ 47, bn, and C37).
  • the temperature corrected plasma glucose concentration curve in Figure 15 was then computed at each temperature read by the thermocouple by inputting into Equations 2 and 3 these 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters (a 37 , bn, and c 37 ), the TempCos ( m OT , m ⁇ , m Cr , ⁇ , ⁇ , and ⁇ , as determined in the table above), and the corresponding temperature read by the thermocouple.
  • the temperature corrected plasma glucose concentration curve matches closely the reference plasma glucose levels (indicated by the small and medium sized circles) in Figure 15. In fact, the mean absolute relative deviation ("MARD") between the computed temperature corrected plasma glucose concentrations and the reference plasma glucose levels was only 2.46% (excluding the 37 °C reference values used for calibration). The MARD for the same data set without temperature correction was 170%.
  • a solution's measured analyte concentration is to be corrected for pH effects, the pH of the solution must be measured or estimated in some manner.
  • a separate pH sensor may be used to measure pH.
  • the same indicator system which is used to generate a signal indicative of analyte concentration may be used to measure pH.
  • the ratio of two green signals generated by the indicator system may be used to compu through the following relationship:
  • G G 2 is calculated from G, which is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 470nm, and G 2 which is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 420nm.
  • the approximate linearity of the relationship between G G 2 and pH is illustrated in Figure 16 over a range of glucose concentrations ⁇ 50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL) and pH levels (6.8, 7.2, 7.4, and 7.8), although some greater deviation from linearity occurs between pH 7.4 and pH 7.8.
  • G G 2 is represented in Figure 16 as Ibase/Iacid since, as indicated above, 470nm is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's base-form, and 420nm is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's acid-form.
  • the values of G,/G 2 plotted in Figure 16 have been normalized to the 100 mg/dL , pH 7.4 value of G G 2 .
  • Equation 8 may be used to predict pH level from the G G 2 ratio once the constants m pH and ⁇ H have been determined.
  • each analyte measurement device may be individually calibrated to determine the constants m H and ⁇ H appropriate for that individual device.
  • an entire batch of measurement devices may be calibrated by selecting several devices from the batch, determining values of m pH and ⁇ ⁇ for each selected device, and averaging the values of m H and ⁇ H obtained for each selected devices to produce averaged values of m H and ⁇ H valid for the entire batch of measurement devices for use with Equation 8.
  • averaged values of m H and ⁇ ⁇ may be determined as just described, but a one-point calibration is performed to individually calibrate each sensor in the batch while taking advantage of the averaged values of m H and ⁇ ⁇ obtained for the entire batch.
  • the one point calibration performed on each individual measuring device may involve using the individual device to measure G, and G 2 for a standard solution having a glucose concentration of 100 mg/dL at pH 7.4. These values may then be used in Equation 9
  • G is the fluorescent emission, either referenced or unreferenced, at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 470nm, which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's base-form (although other combinations of excitation and emission wavelengths are also feasible for use as the numerator of the G j /G 2 ratio in Equation 9),
  • a measured ratio G l /G 2 may be used in Equation 9 to compute the pH level of the solution of analyte. It was also discovered that the determination of pH from G j /G 2 is effected by the temperature of the solution— see for instance, Example 3, below. Moreover, for purposes of estimating pH from the measured ratio G G 2 , the temperature dependence may be taken into account by allowing m pH and ⁇ H to vary with temperature. In particular, the temperature dependence of m pH and ⁇ H may be modeled using Equations 10 and 11 :
  • Equation 11 k * sfr + k
  • Figure 19 shows the ratio of the measured values of G x and G 2 from Figures 17 and 18 plotted versus pH at each of the four temperatures.
  • a line was fit (using linear regression) to each series of G G 2 values corresponding to the same temperature.
  • Figure 19 illustrates that the intercepts of these lines, and to a lesser extent the slopes of these lines, vary with temperature. To model this temperature dependence, the associated slopes and intercepts are plotted as functions of temperature in Figure 20. Equation 10 was used to model the temperature dependence of the slope m H , and based on the data displayed in Figure 20 best fit values of the constants h, and i were determined.
  • Equation 11 was used to model the temperature dependence of the intercept ⁇ H , and based on the data displayed in Figure 20 best fit values of the constants j, and k were determined. The best fit values of h, and k to be used in Equation 12 are listed in Table 3.
  • Some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein generate a signal indicative of analyte concentration which exhibits a pH dependence. For example, if two solutions of precisely the same analyte concentration are measured at two different pH levels with the same measurement device, in some embodiments, the measurement device may generate differing signals indicative of the two analyte concentrations. Thus, the accuracy of determining a solution's true analyte concentration based on such as signal may be improved by taking the pH of the solution into account.
  • a pH is the first Michaelis-Menten parameter "a”, at a particular pH
  • b H is the second Michaelis-Menten parameter "b”, at the same particular pH
  • c H is the third Michaelis-Menten parameter "c”, at the same particular pH
  • some embodiment methods of estimating an analyte concentration include generating a signal indicative of analyte concentration and a signal indicative of pH.
  • the signal indicative of the analyte concentration and the signal indicative of the pH are both generated from a set of at least two signals each of which is indicative of both the pH and the analyte concentration.
  • these could be the G, and G 2 fluorescent signals described above, both of which are indicative of both analyte concentration and pH.
  • the G 2 fluorescent signal itself may be treated as the signal indicative of analyte concentration, while G 1 and G 2 are used as signals indicative of pH, for example, in the pH determination algorithm described above.
  • the signal indicative of analyte concentration exhibits a pH dependence
  • the signal indicative of pH may be used to adjust the signal indicative of analyte concentration to correct for pH dependence.
  • the methods further include transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation, such as Equation 1 above, depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, such as the parameters "a", "6", and "c", as described above as first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters with reference to Equation 13.
  • Equation 13 The pH dependence of Equation 13 is exhibited through the Michaelis-Menten parameters a pH , b p n, and c pH , as indicated by the subscript "pH" labeling these parameters.
  • the pH dependence may need to be determined through a pH calibration.
  • the values of one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based on data which includes pH calibration data and the signal indicative of a pH.
  • the pH calibration data may be generated by a pH calibration method.
  • the pH calibration method may include selecting a first test analyte sensing element, and creating and/or providing a set of at least three solutions of differing known analyte concentrations.
  • a first pH is selected (pHl)
  • three solutions of the set of at least three solutions are adjusted to a pH substantially similar to the selected first pH
  • a first set of at least three signals is generated using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different one of the three solutions at the first pH. Measurements are then made at a second pH.
  • a second pH is selected (pH2)
  • three solutions of the set of at least three solutions are adjusted to a pH substantially similar to the selected second pH
  • a second set of at least three signals is generated using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different one of the three solutions at the second pH.
  • more than three solutions may be used in either of these steps.
  • more than two pHs may also be employed. Generally, the more solutions of differing concentration and the greater number of different pHs that are employed, the greater the accuracy of the resulting calibration data.
  • the sets of signals are used to determine (usually approximately) the relationship between one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters and pH.
  • the pH calibration method may further include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH ⁇ a p m, b pH i, and c pH i) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a first fit dataset comprising the first set of at least three signals.
  • the pH calibration method may further include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH (a p m, b P H2, and c pH 2) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a second fit dataset comprising the second set of at least three signals.
  • each of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters has been determined at least two pHs, providing data which may be used to create a model of the pH dependence of each of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters.
  • the pH calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the first Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH, the equation depending on a first set of pH calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the first set of calibration parameters based on the value of the first Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH (a P m) and the value of the first Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH ( ⁇ 3 ⁇ 4,. 3 ⁇ 4 ) ⁇
  • similar steps are performed with respect to the second and third Michaelis-Menten parameters (b p n and c pH ).
  • the pH calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the second Michaelis-Menten parameter (Z / ) to pH, the equation depending on a second set of pH calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the second set of calibration parameters based on the value of the second Michaelis- Menten parameter at the first pH (3 ⁇ 4 # ;) and the value of the second Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH (3 ⁇ 4 /3 ⁇ 4 ) ⁇
  • the pH calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the third Michaelis-Menten parameter (C P H) to pH, the equation depending on a third set of pH calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the third set of calibration parameters based on the value of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH (c pH] ) and the value of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH ⁇ c P H2)-
  • equations linear in pH may be selected to relate the first and second Michaelis-Menten parameters to pH, while a more complicated equation may be selected to relate the third Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH.
  • the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters may be written as
  • each Michaelis-Menten parameter a p n, b p n, and C P H is determined by multiplying the pH 7.4 Michael is-Menten parameter a . , b 7.4 , and c 7 . 4 , by its corresponding "pH correction factor," p a ij (pH), p b w (pH), or p C fj (pH), respectively.
  • the pH 7.4 Michael is-Menten parameter a . , b 7.4 , and c 7 . 4 is determined by multiplying the pH 7.4 Michael is-Menten parameter a . , b 7.4 , and c 7 . 4 , by its corresponding "pH correction factor," p a ij (pH), p b w (pH), or p C fj (pH), respectively.
  • Michaelis-Menten parameters may be determined by fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a set of signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a plurality of solutions of differing analyte concentrations held at pH 7.4, as described above with respect to, for example, pHl and pH2.
  • the parameters a 7 . 4 , b 4 , and c 7 . 4 may be supplied by a factory calibration as described in provisional U.S. patent application No. 61/184,747, "Algorithms for Calibrating an Analyte Sensor," filed June 5, 2009, which is hereby incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • 4 , b 4 , and c 4 may be determine via a one-point in vivo calibration as also disclosed in the same application.
  • some embodiment methods may select a first equation linear in pH to relate the first Michaelis- Menten parameter to pH, and select a second equation linear in pH to relate the second Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH.
  • an equation is selected to relate the third Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH which comprises a fraction wherein the numerator is equal to an exponential function of an equation linear in the inverse of pH, and the denominator is equal to an exponential function of the same linear function in the inverse of pH evaluated at pH 7.4. If such equations in pH are selected, then the pH correction factors may be written as
  • pH calibration coefficients (pHCos)
  • analytic functional forms other than linear equations may be chosen to relate the pH correction factors and/or Michaelis-Menten parameters to pH (or to inverses of pH as indicated by Equation 15's expression for p c (pH)).
  • quadratic or higher-order polynomials in pH may be appropriate and/or desirable.
  • a pH calibration method used to determine values of these pHCos may require that values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters be determined at a second pH (pH2), different than pH 7.4. Values of the parameters at the second pH (a p , b p m, and C p ui) may be determined by fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a set of signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a plurality of solutions of differing analyte concentrations held at the second pH, as described above with respect to, for example, pHl and pH2.
  • the pH calibration coefficients m a h and ⁇ ⁇ h may be determined by normalizing to 07 , 4 both a P H2 and 07 , 4, yielding a pH2 / 74 and 1, and fitting a line to the normalized values versus the two pHs, pH2 and pH 7.4.
  • the fit may be determined using linear least squares or any other method of fitting a line to a set of points.
  • the pH calibration coefficient, m a h is set equal to the slope of the resulting line and the pH calibration coefficient, ⁇ ⁇ H , is set equal to the intercept.
  • the pH calibration coefficients m b h and 3 ⁇ 4 h may be determined the same way from values of b p m and £7.4.
  • the pH calibration coefficients m and ? may be determined from values of c P H2 and C7.4, however an additional step of linearizing Equation 15's expression for p c h (pH) must first be performed.
  • a pH corrected estimated glucose concentration [G/W] ) may be computed from a fluorescent signal ( G, ) measured at a particular pH, by using the pHCos ( ⁇ ⁇ , ⁇ ⁇ , m bfH , ⁇ ⁇ , m CpH , and ⁇ ), the pH 7.4 Michaelis-Menten parameters (07.4, b .
  • Equation 13 Equation 13
  • the first set of pH calibration parameters comprises the slope and intercept of a first equation linear in pH
  • the second set of pH calibration parameters comprises the slope and intercept of a second equation linear in pH
  • the third set of pH calibration parameters may comprise the slope and intercept of an equation linear in the inverse of pH which is related to the third Michaelis-Menten parameter through an exponential function divided by a constant— wherein the constant is equal to the result of evaluating the exponential function of the same equation linear in the inverse of pH evaluated at a fixed pH level.
  • the pH calibration parameters may comprise constants associated with analytic functional forms other than linear equations which may be suitable and/or desirable.
  • the pHCos may include the coefficients of quadratic or higher-order polynomials in pH.
  • each measurement device When measurement devices are mass produced, it may not be feasible or practical to individually calibrate each measurement device— i.e. use each individual measurement device to generate individual calibration data. It may be more cost effective to select one or more test devices from a batch of mass produced devices, generate calibration data using the one or more test devices, and provide that calibration data to each individual devices produced in the batch.
  • variability between measurement devices from the same production batch may be, to a large extent, attributable to a particular part of the measurement device.
  • variability between devices may be attributable to the part of the measurement device which generates a signal indicative of analyte concentration— e.g.
  • the calibration method may further include selecting a second test analyte sensing element; generating a third set of at least three signals using the second test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of known analyte concentration at the first pH ipHl); and generating a fourth set of at least three signals using the second test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of known analyte concentration at the second pH (pH2).
  • calibration methods may similarly employ more than two test devices, or more particularly, for instance, more than two test analyte sensing elements.
  • the sets of signals are used to determine (usually approximately) the relationship between one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters and pH.
  • the pH calibration method may further include (1) computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH (a p m, b p ni, and C P HI) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a first fit dataset comprising both the first set of at least three signals (which was generated with the first test analyte sensing element at pHl) and the third set of at least three signals (which was generated with the second test analyte sensing element at pHl); and (2) computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH ( ⁇ 3 ⁇ 4, /# , b p m, and c p/# ) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a second fit dataset comprising both the second set of at least three signals (which was generated with the first test analyte sensing element at pH2) and fourth set of at least three signals
  • the signals generated with the second test analyte sensing element are used in a combined fit with the signals generated with the first test analyte sensing element, which results in values for each of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters which take both test analyte sensing elements into account.
  • a pH calibration method may take both test analyte sensing elements into account by fitting the signals generated from each test analyte sensing element separately, and then averaging the results to obtain better estimates of the Michaelis-Menten parameters.
  • the step of computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis- Menten parameter at the first pH ⁇ a p m, b P Hi, and C P J) by an algorithm may further include fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a third fit dataset comprising the third set of at least three signals, and averaging the results of fitting the third fit dataset with the results of fitting the first fit dataset.
  • the step of computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH ⁇ a p m, b P H2, and C P ET) by an algorithm may further include fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a fourth fit dataset comprising the fourth set of at least three signals, and averaging the results of fitting the fourth fit dataset with the results of fitting the second fit dataset.
  • a method of estimating an analyte concentration from a signal indicative of the analyte concentration may include transforming the signal using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein the values of one or more Michaelis-Menten parameters have been adjusted for pH.
  • a method of estimating an analyte concentration may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration and generating a signal indicative of a pH, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more pH calibration parameters and the signal indicative of pH.
  • a "substituted" equation exhibits a more complicated analytic form, it nevertheless will still express the basic functional relationships of the modified Michaelis- Menten equation.
  • the step of transforming the signal indicative of analyte concentration may utilize a "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation in which each of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters have been substituted with first, second, and third calibration equations (respectively), each of the equations depending on sets of first, second, and third pH calibration parameters (respectively), and each also depending on the signal indicative of pH.
  • at least one of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a polynomial in the signal indicative of pH.
  • each of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a polynomial in the signal indicative of pH.
  • At least one of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a linear equation in the signal indicative of pH.
  • the first and second calibration equations are a linear equations in the signal indicative of pH
  • the third calibration equation comprises a fraction wherein the numerator is equal to an exponential function of an equation linear in the inverse of the signal indicative of pH, and the denominator is equal to an exponential function of the same linear function in the inverse of the signal indicative of pH evaluated at fixed pH.
  • Za H 2 > Xa H ⁇ > an d Za favor o are polynomial coefficients parameterizing a p// 's dependence on the pH level
  • the "substituted" equations (Equations 16 and 17) exhibit a more complicated analytic form, they nevertheless still exhibit the basic functional relationships of the modified Michaelis-Menten equation (Equation 13).
  • the calibration equations substituted into the modified Michaelis-Menten equation may have a functional form other than a polynomial in pH.
  • each set of pH calibration parameters may be determined by fitting the "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a plurality of signals, the plurality of signals indicative of analyte concentration in a plurality of solutions at a plurality of pHs. Once values of the various pH calibration parameters are determined, pH corrected estimates of analyte concentrations may be generated from signals indicative of analyte concentration and pH.
  • This example concerns the pH calibration of an equilibrium fluorescence glucose GluCath sensor.
  • the GluCath sensor employs an HPTS-Cys-MA dye operably coupled to a 3,3'-oBBV quencher, with the dye and quencher immobilized within a hydrogel disposed along the distal region of an optical fiber, while the proximal end of the optical fiber is coupled to a light source.
  • the pH dependence of this sensor's fluorescence response to glucose was assumed to approximately follow the modified Michaelis-Menten equation labeled as Equation 13 and described above.
  • the Michaelis-Menten a H , b pH , and c pH parameters were assumed to bear the relationships to pH set forth in Equations 14 and 15 above.
  • the a H and b H Michaelis-Menten parameters were assumed to depend linearly on pH, while the c pH
  • the effect of pH on the fluorescent signal was determined experimentally by measuring the signal at five pH levels (6.8, 7.0, 7.2, 7.4, and 7.6) and four glucose concentrations (50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL).
  • the stable fluorescent signals j and G 2 were recorded, as displayed in Figure 22.
  • Figure 22 illustrates that the data corresponding to a fixed glucose concentration of 100 mg/dL exhibits the lowest fluorescent intensity at the lowest pH (pH 6.8), and the highest fluorescent intensity at the highest pH (pH 7.6)— and, more generally, that the intensity increases monotonically as a function of pH.
  • the modulation due to glucose changes inversely with pH—that is, the modulation (the ratio of fluorescent intensity at high glucose concentration versus low glucose concentration) is lowest at high pH and highest at low pH.
  • Values of the stable fluorescent signal G2 taken from Figure 22 are replotted in Figure 23 versus glucose concentration— each curve corresponding to a fixed pH level. Since the five constant-pH curves in Figure 23 are generally non-overlapping, it is clear that changes in pH level have an effect on the G2 fluorescent signal.
  • Figures 24 and 25 illustrate that values of the first and second Michaelis-Menten parameters, a p n and b p n, respectively, vary approximately linearly with pH level, while the value of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter, c pH , exhibits some degree of non-linear variation with pH.
  • Equations 14 and 15 were chosen to model a p n, b P H, and C P H, as described above.
  • the pH calibration parameters corresponding to Equations 14 and 15 were determined by normalizing each of the "a" parameters to a 74 , and fitting a line (again using linear least squares) to a plot of these values— i.e. 68 / ⁇ 74 , ⁇ 70 / ⁇ 74 , ⁇ 72 / ⁇ 74 , 1 , ⁇ 76 / ⁇ 74 versus pH— the slope and intercept being m a h and ⁇ ⁇ h , respectively.
  • [Glu] is the estimated glucose concentration
  • a T pH is the first Michaelis-Menten parameter "a”, at a particular temperature and pH
  • b T pH is the second Michaelis-Menten parameter "b”, at the same particular temperature and pH
  • some embodiment methods of estimating an analyte concentration include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, a signal indicative of a temperature, and a signal indicative of a pH.
  • the signal indicative of the analyte concentration and the signal indicative of the pH are both generated from a set of at least two signals each of which is indicative of both the pH and the analyte concentration. For instance, these could be the G j and G 2 fluorescent signals described above, both of which are indicative of both analyte concentration and pH.
  • the G 2 fluorescent signal itself may be treated as the signal indicative of analyte concentration, while G, and G 2 are used as signals indicative of pH, for example, in the pH determination algorithm described above.
  • the signal indicative of the analyte concentration, the signal indicative of the temperature, and the signal indicative of the pH are each generated from a set of at least three signals each of which is indicative of the temperature, the pH, and the analyte concentration.
  • the signal indicative of the analyte concentration exhibits a temperature dependence and a pH dependence which may be quantitatively characterized by a modified Michaelis-Menten equation (as described above)
  • methods accomplishing temperature and pH correction may further include transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation, such as Equation 18 above, depending on Michaelis- Menten parameters, such as the parameters " ", "b”, and "c", as described above as first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters with reference to Equation 18.
  • Equation 18 The temperature and pH dependence of Equation 18 is exhibited through the Michaelis-Menten parameters a T pH , b T pH , and c T pH , as indicated by the subscripts "I" and
  • the temperature and pH dependence may need to be determined through a calibration method.
  • the values of one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based on data which includes temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of temperature, and the signal indicative of a pH.
  • the temperature and pH calibration parameters may be determined by a calibration method.
  • the calibration method may include selecting a first test analyte sensing element, selecting three differing concentrations of analyte, selecting a first temperature (77) and a second temperature (72) (the second differing from the first), and selecting a first pH ipHl) and a second pH (pH2) (the second differing from the first). Once these selections are made, the calibration method may include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the selected first temperature (77).
  • This computation may employ an algorithm which includes fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the selected three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the selected first temperature (77).
  • the three signals may be generated, for example, by using the first test analyte sensing element to measure the concentration of analyte in each solution of a set of three solutions, each of which has been prepared so as to contain one of the three selected concentrations of analyte adjusted to the first selected temperature (Tl).
  • the calibration method may include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the selected second temperature (T2).
  • This computation may employ an algorithm which includes fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the selected three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the selected second temperature (T2).
  • the three signals may be generated, for example, by using the first test analyte sensing element to measure the concentration of analyte in each solution of a set of three solutions, each of which has been prepared so as to contain one of the three selected concentrations of analyte adjusted to the second selected temperature (T2).
  • the calibration method may include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the selected first pH level ipHl) and the selected second pH level (pH2).
  • the computation with respect to the selected first pH level (pHl) may employ an algorithm which includes fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the selected three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the selected first pH level (pHl).
  • the three signals may be generated, for example, by using the first test analyte sensing element to measure the concentration of analyte in each solution of a set of three solutions, each of which has been prepared so as to contain one of the three selected concentrations of analyte adjusted to the first selected pH level (pHl).
  • the computation with respect to the selected second pH level (pH2) may employ an algorithm which includes fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the selected three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the selected second pH level ipH2).
  • the three signals may be generated, for example, by using the second test analyte sensing element to measure the concentration of analyte in each solution of a set of three solutions, each of which has been prepared so as to contain one of the three selected concentrations of analyte adjusted to the second selected pH level (pH2).
  • a relationship between each Michaelis-Menten parameter and temperature and pH may be determined.
  • a first calibration equation is selected to relate the first Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH.
  • the equation may depend on a first set of temperature and pH calibration parameters.
  • a value for each parameter is set based on the values of the first Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature ( T j), the second temperature the first pH (a p m), and the second pH ( ⁇ 3 ⁇ 4,/ 3 ⁇ 4 ) ⁇
  • a second calibration equation is selected to relate the second Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH.
  • the equation may depend on a second set of temperature and pH calibration parameters.
  • a value for each parameter is set based on the values of the second Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (bn), the second temperature ( ⁇ 2 ), the first pH (b P Hi), and the second pH (b P E2)-
  • a third calibration equation is selected to relate the third Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH.
  • the equation may depend on a third set of temperature and pH calibration parameters.
  • a value for each parameter is set based on the values of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (cjj), the second temperature (c ⁇ ), the first pH (C P I), and the second pH (C P H2)-
  • a calibration equation which is selected to relate one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters to temperature and pH may consist of any functional relationship which satisfactorily relates the parameter to temperature and pH once the equation's calibration parameters (if any) are determined.
  • Suitable calibration equations include analytic functions such as polynomial functions in temperature and pH.
  • the phrase "calibration equation" is used herein to generally denote any functional relationship between one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters and temperature and pH.
  • a lookup table specifying a value of any Michaelis- Menten parameter based on particular values of temperature and pH is considered a "calibration equation" as that phrase is used herein.
  • a set of multiple analytic functions which individually apply over particular ranges of temperatures and pHs is also considered a "calibration equation" as that phrase is used herein.
  • the first calibration equation (i.e. selected to relate the first Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH) comprises a product of a first pH-independent function and a first temperature-independent function.
  • the second calibration equation is the product of a second pH-independent function and a second temperature-independent function
  • the third calibration equation is the product of a third pH-independent function and a third temperature-independent function.
  • calibration equations meeting these criteria may be represented by the following expression:
  • T Ct (T) are "temperature correction factors" which approximately account for the temperature dependence of a T pH , b T pH , and c T pH ;
  • p a H (pH), p b fi (pH), and p c ⁇ pH) are "pH correction factors” which approximately account for the pH dependence of a T pH , b T pH , and c T pH ;
  • 0 , b 0 , c 0 are constants set equal to the value of a T pH , b T pH , and c T pH determined at a particular selected standard temperature and pH level.
  • each Michaelis-Menten parameter a T pH , b T pH , c T pH
  • a Q , b Q , c 0 the value at the selected standard temperature and pH level
  • a Q , b Q , c 0 the value at the selected standard temperature and pH level
  • a Q , b Q , c 0 the value at the selected standard temperature and pH level
  • a Q , b Q , c 0 by its corresponding "temperature correction factor,” ⁇ ⁇ ⁇ ), T CT (T)
  • pH correction factor p a H ( >H)
  • p b ft (pH) the order of multiplication is irrelevant when the temperature and pH dependence are modeled in this manner.
  • the standard temperature and pH Michaelis-Menten parameters, a 0 , b Q , c 0 may be determined by fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a set of signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a plurality of solutions of differing analyte concentrations held at the selected standard temperature and pH level.
  • the parameters a Q , b 0 , and c 0 may be supplied by a factory calibration as described in provisional
  • the first, second, and third pH- independent functions may be selected so as to be linear in temperature; the first and second temperature-independent functions may be selected so as to be linear in pH; and the third temperature-independent function may be selected to be a fraction wherein the numerator is equal to an exponential function of a third function linear in the inverse of pH, and the denominator is equal to an exponential function of the same function linear in the inverse of pH evaluated at pH 7.4.
  • Calibration equations satisfying these criteria may be written as:
  • the first set of temperature and pH calibration parameters comprise the slope and intercept of the first pH-independent function and the slope and intercept of the first temperature independent function.
  • the second set of temperature and pH calibration parameters comprise the slope and intercept of the second pH- independent function and the slope and intercept of the second temperature independent function
  • the third set of temperature and pH calibration parameters comprise the slope and intercept of the third pH-independent function and the slope and intercept of the third function linear in the signal indicative of pH.
  • Equation 19 J3 b fl , m c h , and ⁇ 0 h ) determined above separately with respect to temperature and pH may be used in Equation 19, provided that a 0 , b Q , and b Q are determined in a manner consistent with the determination of the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters, a 37 , bn, C37, and the pH 7.4 Michaelis- Menten parameters, a 7 . 4 , b 7 . 4 , c 7 . 4 .
  • Equation 19 an expression for computing a temperature and pH corrected glucose concentration may be given by (EqUatl ° n where:
  • [GIU] is the estimated glucose concentration
  • a T pH , b T pH , and c T pH are the Michaelis-Menten parameters, at a particular temperature and pH
  • ⁇ 3 ⁇ 4 7 74 , £ 37 74 , and c 37 74 are the Michaelis-Menten parameters determined at 37 °C and pH 7.4,
  • T aT ( T ) > ⁇ ( ⁇ ), cT ( T ) > P apH ipH), P bpH ⁇ pH), and P CpH pH) are given by Equations 3 and 15, and
  • G 2 is the fluorescent emission, either referenced or unreferenced, at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 420nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's acid-form). Note, however, that other combinations of excitation and emission wavelengths are also feasible for use in Equation 20. In Example 5 below, G 2 has been used.
  • This example concerns the simultaneous temperature and pH calibration of an equilibrium fluorescence glucose GluCath sensor, and an assessment of the accuracy of the calibration by comparison with an independent data set.
  • the GluCath sensor employs an HPTS-Cys-MA dye operably coupled to a 3,3'-oBBV quencher, with the dye and quencher immobilized within a hydrogel disposed along the distal region of an optical fiber, while the proximal end of the optical fiber is coupled to a light source.
  • the temperature and pH dependence of this sensor's fluorescence response to glucose was assumed to approximately follow Equation 20— using the TempCos from Table 2 and the pHCos from Table 5.
  • the 37 °C, pH 7.4 Michaelis-Menten parameters, a 37 74 , b J1 74 , c 31 74 , appearing in Equation 20 were determined by averaging data over multiple sensors derived from fitting a modified Michaelis- Menten equation to three solutions having known glucose concentrations of 0 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL, followed by a single measurement at 100 mg/dL using the individual sensor to adjust the parameters to the individual sensor. [0262] To test the calibration, measurements were made on two different glucose solution concentrations (50 mg/dL and 100 mg/dL), at two different temperatures (30 °C and 40 °Q, and at two different pH levels (pH 7.400 and pH 7.035).
  • a method of estimating an analyte concentration from a signal indicative of the analyte concentration may include transforming the signal using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein the values of one or more Michaelis-Menten parameters have been adjusted for temperature and pH.
  • a method of estimating an analyte concentration of a solution may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the solution, generating a signal indicative of a temperature of the solution, generating a signal indicative of a pH of the solution, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of the temperature, and the signal indicative of the pH.
  • the step of transforming the signal indicative of analyte concentration may utilize a "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation in which each of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters have been substituted with first, second, and third calibration equations (respectively), each of the equations depending on sets of first, second, and third temperature and pH calibration parameters (respectively), and each also depending on the signal indicative of temperature and the signal indicative of pH.
  • the first calibration equation is the product of a first pH-independent polynomial in the signal indicative of temperature and a first temperature- independent polynomial in the signal indicative of pH.
  • the second calibration equation is the product of a second pH-independent polynomial in the signal indicative of temperature and a second temperature-independent polynomial in the signal indicative of pH; and the third calibration equation is the product of a third pH-independent polynomial in the signal indicative of temperature and a third temperature-independent function of the signal indicative of pH.
  • one or more of the first, second, and third pH-independent polynomials are linear equations in the signal indicative of temperature
  • one or more of the first and second temperature-independent polynomials are linear equations in the signal indicative of pH
  • the third temperature-independent function is a fraction wherein the numerator is equal to an exponential function of a function linear in the inverse of the signal indicative of pH, and the denominator is equal to an exponential function of the same function linear in the inverse of the signal indicative of pH evaluated at pH 7.4.
  • transforming the signal indicative of analyte concentration using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis- Menten equation may utilize a look-up table.
  • function evaluation by use of a look-up table may be more computationally efficient than direct application of the same function as it is written.
  • the lookup table consists of a set of discrete matching input and output values, e.g. (x, y) pairs.
  • Evaluating the function fix) or computing the output value j which corresponds to a given input value x may be accomplished by looking up the input value x in the look-up table, and choosing the output value y in the table which corresponds to it. If the exact input value does not exist in the look-up table, the corresponding output value may be determined by interpolating from the output values in the table whose corresponding input values are similar to the original input value.
  • Such methodology may be more efficient than evaluating a function, when looking up values in the look-up table and interpolating between values when necessary is quicker than applying the function as written to a given input value.
  • use of a look-up table should be understood to simply be a potentially efficient way to approximate the application of a function in analytic form.
  • the calibration equations substituted into the modified Michaelis-Menten equation for the Michaelis-Menten parameters may take a variety of functional forms and each may have varying numbers of temperature and pH calibration parameters. Obviously, more complicated equations may have a greater numbers of temperature and pH calibration parameters. In any event, depending on the embodiment, various temperature and pH calibration methods may be used to determine the values of the first, second, and third sets of the one or more temperature and pH calibration parameters.
  • each set of temperature and pH calibration parameters may be determined by fitting the "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a plurality of signals, the plurality of signals indicative of analyte concentration in a plurality of solutions having differing analyte concentrations, at a plurality of temperatures, and at a plurality of pH levels. Once values of the various temperature and pH calibration parameters are determined, temperature and pH corrected estimates of analyte concentrations may be generated from signals indicative of analyte concentration, temperature, and pH.

Abstract

Disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration which include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a temperature, generating a signal indicative of a pH, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data which includes temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of a temperature, and the signal indicative of a pH. Also disclosed herein are measurement devices which employ the aforementioned methods.

Description

MEASUREMENT DEVICES AND METHODS FOR MEASURING ANALYTE CONCENTRATION INCORPORATING TEMPERATURE AND PH CORRECTION
CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
[0001] This application claims priority to U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 61/313,066, filed March 11, 2011 the disclosure of which is hereby expressly incorporated by reference and hereby expressly made a portion of this application. This application is also related to co-pending U.S. Patent Application No. 12/794,466, filed June 4, 2010, the disclosure of each of which are hereby expressly incorporated by reference in their entireties and are hereby expressly made a portion of this application.
BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
Field of the Invention
[0002] The present application discloses embodiments which relate to the field of analyte concentration measurement, more specifically, glucose concentration measurement, and, in some embodiments, algorithms and methods of temperature and/or pH correction, and measurement devices which perform temperature and/or pH correction.
Description of the Related Art
[0003] Types 1 and 2 diabetes are endocrine disorders characterized by abnormalities in the body's ability to regulate glucose metabolism. While the underlying pathology of these two illnesses differ, both are associated with significant complications including diabetic nephropathy, neuropathy, retinopathy, problems with wound healing, as well as an elevated risk of cerebrovascular and cardiovascular disease. While the mechanism of action is uncertain, it is believed that elevated glucose levels are associated with the release of various inflammatory mediators that produce vascular damage ultimately leading to these complications. Abnormally low glucose levels can also be problematic resulting in anxiety, weakness, and in extreme cases coma and death. Researchers and clinicians have increasingly become aware of the importance of maintaining tight control of glucose levels, particularly in acute care settings, so as to prevent these complications from occurring and to facilitate patient recovery.
[0004] While clinicians have used insulin for decades to regulate glucose levels in diabetics, determining precise dosages remains a problem. Insulin has the overall effect of reducing circulating glucose levels through a series of complex interactions involving a number of hormones and cell types. While dosage protocols for insulin attempt to replicate the physiologic secretion of the hormone by the pancreas, administering according to fixed times and algorithms based on serum glucose measurements can only crudely approximate the ability of a healthy individual to continuously adjust insulin production in response to glucose levels and the needs of the body. It follows that in order to determine the precise amount of insulin that must be administered to maintain a patient's circulating glucose levels at a normal level, it is necessary to have an extremely accurate measurement of how much glucose is present and available to the patient at any given time.
[0005] Unfortunately, existing methods of determining a patient's glucose level leave much to be desired. Clinicians and diabetic patients routinely test glucose levels by testing unprocessed blood. While the results can be available quickly, they can often be inaccurate. Glucose freely diffuses in and out of red blood cells which can cause the result to vary depending on the concentration of such cells in the sample. Furthermore, the diffusion of glucose out of blood cells is often magnified by the requirement that the whole blood be diluted, thus altering the osmotic potential across the membranes of the blood cells.
[0006] A more accurate determination of the patient's glucose level can be obtained by measuring plasma glucose. This requires the separation of the plasma from the other components of the blood such as red and white blood cells. There exist a number of analytical methods for measuring plasma glucose concentration. These include the measurement of the current produced by glucose oxidation, the use of the hexokinase reaction, or through the use of mass spectrometry. While the latter represents the "gold standard" for glucose measurement, these methods can be technically complicated, time-consuming, and are frequently not cost- effective for clinical use. For example, for the most accurate readings, lipids should be removed from the plasma and the results should be adjusted for the sodium content, but both are rarely done. Finally, the results can vary depending on how much protein-bound and intercellular glucose has been released into the sample prior to and during processing. While plasma glucose measurements can provide relatively accurate information, transportation and processing times can lead to a significant delay between when the sample is collected and when the results are available to the clinician. Therefore, it is not feasible to use plasma glucose measurements for near-instantaneous, or "real-time" monitoring of a patient's glucose level. SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
[0007] Disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a temperature, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data which may include temperature calibration data and the signal indicative of a temperature.
[0008] Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a temperature, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more temperature calibration parameters and the signal indicative of temperature.
[0009] Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a pH, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data which may include pH calibration data, and the signal indicative of a pH.
[0010] Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a pH, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more pH calibration parameters and the signal indicative of pH.
[0011] Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, generating a signal indicative of a temperature, generating a signal indicative of a pH, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data which may include temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of a temperature, and the signal indicative of a pH.
[0012] Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration of a solution which may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the solution, generating a signal indicative of a temperature of the solution, generating a signal indicative of a pH of the solution, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of the temperature, and the signal indicative of the pH.
[0013] Also disclosed herein are measurement devices for estimating an analyte concentration of a sample. In some embodiments, the measurement devices may include an analyte sensing element, a temperature sensing element, and a receiving and processing unit. In some embodiments, the analyte sensing element may be configured to generate a first signal, the first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample. In some embodiments, the temperature sensing element may be configured to generate a second signal, the second signal indicative of a temperature of the sample. In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit may be configured to transform the first signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data which may include temperature calibration data, and the second signal.
[0014] The measurement devices for estimating an analyte concentration of a sample may, in some embodiments, include an analyte sensing element, a pH sensing element, and a receiving and processing unit. In some embodiments, the analyte sensing element may be configured to generate a first signal, the first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample. In some embodiments, the pH sensing element may be configured to generate a second signal, the second signal indicative of a pH of the sample. In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit may be configured to transform the first signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending upon Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data which may include pH calibration data, and the second signal.
[0015] The measurement devices for estimating an analyte concentration of a sample, may, in some embodiments, include an analyte sensing element, a temperature sensing element, and a pH sensing element. In some embodiments, the analyte sensing element may be configured to generate a first signal, the first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample. In some embodiments, the temperature sensing element may be configured to generate a second signal, the second signal indicative of a temperature of the sample. In some embodiments, the pH sensing element may be configured to generate a third signal, the third signal indicative of a pH of the sample. In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit may be configured to transform the first signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data which may include temperature and pH calibration data, the second signal, and the third signal.
[0016] The measurement devices for estimating an analyte concentration of a sample, may, in some embodiments, include an analyte and pH sensing element, and a receiving and processing unit. In some embodiments, the analyte and pH sensing element may be configured to generate a first signal, the first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and a pH of the sample. In some embodiments, the analyte and pH sensing element may be configured to generate a second signal, the second signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and the pH of the sample. In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit may be configured to transform a third signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data which may include pH calibration data and a fourth signal. In some embodiments, the third signal may be indicative of the analyte concentration and may be generated based upon data which may include the first signal and the second signal. In some embodiments, the fourth signal may be indicative of the pH and may be generated based upon data which may include the first signal and the second signal.
[0017] The measurement devices for estimating an analyte concentration of a sample may, in some embodiments, include an analyte and pH sensing element, a temperature sensing element, and a receiving and processing unit. In some embodiments, the analyte and pH sensing element may be configured to generate a first signal, the first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and a pH of the sample, and a second signal, the second signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and the pH of the sample. In some embodiments, the temperature sensing element may be configured to generate a third signal, the third signal indicative of a temperature of the sample. In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit may be configured to transform a fourth signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data which may include temperature and pH calibration data, the third signal, and a fifth signal. In some embodiments, the fourth signal may be indicative of the analyte concentration and may be generated based upon data which may include the first signal and the second signal. In some embodiments, the fifth signal may be indicative of the pH and may be generated based upon data which may include the first signal and the second signal.
[0018] Also disclosed herein are methods of estimating an analyte concentration from a signal indicative of the analyte concentration. In some embodiments, the methods may include transforming the signal using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein the values of one or more Michaelis-Menten parameters have been adjusted for temperature. In some embodiments, the values of one or more Michaelis-Menten parameters may also have been adjusted for pH.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0019] Figure 1A is a flow chart schematically illustrating the sensing mechanism of one embodiment of the present invention which includes a temperature sensing element and an analyte sensing element.
[0020] Figure IB is a flow chart schematically illustrating the sensing mechanism of one embodiment of the present invention which includes an analyte sensing element and a pH sensing element.
[0021] Figure 1C is a flow chart schematically illustrating the sensing mechanism of one embodiment of the present invention which includes a pH and analyte sensing element.
[0022] Figure ID is a flow chart schematically illustrating the sensing mechanism of one embodiment of the present invention which includes a temperature sensing element, an analyte sensing element, and a pH sensing element. [0023] Figure IE is a flow chart schematically illustrating the sensing mechanism of one embodiment of the present invention which includes a temperature sensing element and a pH and analyte sensing element.
[0024] Figure 2A schematically illustrates a dual light source, dual detector measurement device in accordance with certain embodiments disclosed herein.
[0025] Figure 2B schematically illustrates a dual light source measurement device incorporating a microspectrometer and/or spectrometer in accordance with certain embodiments disclosed herein.
[0026] Figure 2C schematically illustrates a dual light source, dual detector measurement system incorporating a beam splitter in accordance with certain embodiments disclosed herein.
[0027] Figure 3 is a cut-away view of a sensor probe wherein a portion of the porous membrane sheath is cut away to expose the optical fiber and hydrogel beneath the membrane.
[0028] Figure 4 is a cross-sectional view along a longitudinal axis of a sensor probe with a hydrogel disposed in the sensor probe distal to the optical fiber.
[0029] Figure 5A shows a sensor probe having a series of holes that form a helical configuration.
[0030] Figure 5B shows a sensor probe having a series of holes drilled or formed at an angle.
[0031] Figure 5C shows a sensor probe having at least one spiral groove.
[0032] Figure 5D shows a sensor probe having a series of triangular wedge cut-outs.
[0033] Figure 6 shows a cross-sectional view of one embodiment of a sensor probe having a cavity in the distal portion of the sensor probe.
[0034] Figure 7A shows a sensor probe with a protective housing surrounding an indicator system, the protective housing including a tubular mesh surrounded by a polymeric material with an open window leading to the indicator system.
[0035] Figure 7B shows a sensor probe with a protective housing surrounding an indicator system, the protective housing including a coil surrounded by a polymeric material with an open window leading to the indicator system. [0036] Figure 8 displays four plots of fluorescent signal versus glucose concentration at four different temperatures generated by one embodiment of a measurement device disclosed herein.
[0037] Figure 9 displays the four plots of Figure 8 with each constant temperature plot normalized to the value of its fluorescent signal at 50 mg/dL.
[0038] Figure 10 displays essentially the same raw data as Figure 8, but instead displays four plots of fluorescent signal versus temperature at four different glucose concentrations.
[0039] Figure 1 1 displays the fluorescent signal generated by one embodiment of an analyte measuring device disclosed herein at four temperatures and four glucose concentrations.
[0040] Figure 12 displays a plot of fluorescent signal versus glucose concentration at four temperatures as generated by one embodiment of an analyte measuring device disclosed herein.
[0041] Figure 13 displays plots of the values of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters versus temperature.
[0042] Figure 14 displays plots of normalized values of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters versus temperature and displays a best fit line associated with each normalized parameter.
[0043] Figure 15 compares a plot of glucose concentration as determined by reference measurements with a plot of glucose concentration as determined by one embodiment of an analyte measuring device disclosed herein.
[0044] Figure 16 displays plots of the ratio of two fluorescent signals versus pH at four glucose concentrations.
[0045] Figure 17 displays plots of two fluorescent signals at four temperatures and four pH levels.
[0046] Figure 18 displays plots of two fluorescent signals at four temperatures and four pH levels.
[0047] Figure 19 displays plots of the ratio of two fluorescent signals versus pH at four temperatures, along with best fit lines corresponding to each temperature.
[0048] Figure 20 displays plots of the slopes and intercepts of the best fit lines of Figure 19 at each of the temperatures from that figure. [0049] Figure 21 compares a plot of pH as determined by reference measurements with a plot of pH as determined by one embodiment of an analyte measuring device disclosed herein.
[0050] Figure 22 displays plots of two fluorescent signals at five pH levels and four glucose concentrations.
[0051] Figure 23 displays plots of fluorescent signal versus glucose concentration at five pH levels.
[0052] Figure 24 displays plots of the values of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters versus pH.
[0053] Figure 25 displays plots of normalized values of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters versus pH.
[0054] Figure 26 compares a plot of glucose concentration as determined by reference measurements with a plot of glucose concentration as determined by one embodiment of an analyte measuring device ("GluCath") disclosed herein.
[0055] Figure 27 displays a magnified portion of the plots of Figure 26.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE PREFERRED EMBODIMENT
[0056] Whole blood glucose activity is a physiologically significant quantity that may be used to determine proper insulin dosage. Glucose activity represents an estimate of the concentration of bioavailable (or free) glucose in water, blood, or any solution. Hence, a patient's whole blood glucose activity level is a physiologically more appropriate quantity by which to estimate insulin dosage, than estimated total blood glucose concentration as determined by the various methods mentioned above. Typically, glucose activity is measured through the establishment of a reversible, equilibrium-based, affinity-driven binding interaction between glucose and some moiety capable of binding free glucose. Glucose activity is not substantially affected by the presence of red blood cells, protein or lipid concentration, nor oxygenation levels. Accordingly, the time consuming step of extracting plasma from whole blood is not required, and glucose activity measurements can be made available in near "real-time." Furthermore, since glucose activity can be measured on whole blood without dilution, it provides an estimate of bioavailable glucose not polluted by the effects of altering away from biological norms, the osmotic potentials across blood cell membranes. [0057] Fluorescent techniques may be used to efficiently and accurately measure the concentration of glucose (and other polyhydroxyl compounds). Oftentimes, these techniques may also be used to measure the concentration of bioavailable glucose in whole blood, i.e. the glucose activity of whole blood. For instance, several attempts have been made to detect glucose by fluorescence using dyes associated with boronic acid groups. Boronate moieties bind glucose reversibly. When boronic acid functionalized fluorescent dyes bind glucose, the properties of the dye are affected, such that a signal related to the concentration of glucose may be generated and detected. For example, Russell (U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,137,833 and 5,512,246) used a boronic acid functionalized dye that bound glucose and generated a signal related to the glucose concentration. James et al. (U.S. Pat. No. 5,503,770) employed a similar principle, but combined a fluorescent dye, an amine quenching functionality, and boronic acid in a single complex. The fluorescence emission from the complex varied with the amount of glucose binding. Van Antwerp et al. (U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,002,954 and 6,011,984) combined features of the previously cited references and also disclosed a device purported to be implantable. A. E. Colvin, Jr. (U.S. Pat. No. 6,304,766) also disclosed optical-based sensing devices for in situ sensing in humans that utilize boronate-functionalized dyes. Suri (U.S. Pat. No. 7,417,164) recently disclosed several fluorescent dyes capable of being used to estimate glucose concentration or activity. Measurement devices
[0058] Various embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein comprise an analyte sensing element configured to generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of a sample. The analyte sensing element may include at least one light source, an indicator system, and at least one detector. In some embodiments, the indicator system (described more fully below) may include at least one type of fluorophore and at least one type of binding moiety. In some embodiments, the fluorophore emits a fluorescence having an intensity in response to light from the at least one light source. In some embodiments, the binding moiety is capable of binding the analyte and is operably coupled to the fluorophore, such that when the sample contacts the binding moiety the intensity is indicative of the concentration of the analyte. In one embodiment, the binding moiety acts as a quencher in the presence of the analyte such that when the binding moiety binds the analyte it interacts with the fluorophore in such a manner as to quench or reduce the fluorescent emission intensity. In preferred embodiments, the binding moiety associates with the fluorophore in the absence of the analyte thereby quenching the fluorescent emission intensity. Analyte binding by the binding moiety causes disassociation from the fluorophore, such that the fluorescent emission intensity increases with increasing concentration of analyte. In some embodiments, the analyte sensing element includes at least one detector which may be configured to detect the intensity and generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration in response to the intensity.
[0059] Examples of glucose-sensing chemical indicator systems and glucose sensor configurations for intravascular glucose monitoring include the optical sensors disclosed in U.S. Patent Nos. 5,137,033, 5,512,246, 5,503,770, 6,627,177, 7,417,164 and 7,470,420, and U.S. Patent Publ. Nos. 2008/0188722, 2008/0188725, 2008/0187655, 2008/0305009, 2009/0018426, 2009/0018418, and co-pending U.S. Patent Appl. Nos. 11/296,898, 12/187,248, 12/172,059, 12/274,617, 12/424,902 and 61/184,747; each of which is incorporated herein in its entirety by reference thereto.
[0060] In some embodiments, the concentration being estimated corresponds to the glucose activity of a sample. In some embodiments, the sample is whole blood. However, the embodiments disclosed herein may also measure the concentrations and/or activities of other analytes. For instance, disclosed measurement devices may, in some embodiments, be configured to measure the concentrations of other polyhydroxyl-containing organic compounds including, but not limited to, carbohydrates, 1,2-diols, 1,3-diols and the like. In some embodiments, the analytes to be measured may include non-carbohydrates. Generally, the measurement devices disclosed herein may be configured to estimate the concentration of any analyte which may be bound by a binding moiety, wherein the binding moiety is operably coupled to a fluorophore which emits a fluorescence indicative of the concentration of the analyte after being excited by light of the appropriate wavelength and intensity. The discussion of the measurement devices that follows will usually refer to the physical quantity to be measured as an "analyte concentration" or simply a "concentration." However, it is to be understood that "concentration" as used below refers to both "analyte concentration" as that phrase would be ordinarily used and also to "activity" (in some cases "glucose activity") as that phrase is described above.
[0061] Various measurement devices disclosed herein are configured to provide improved estimates of the analyte concentration of a particular solution by taking the temperature and/or the pH of the particular solution into account. Accordingly, some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein may include a temperature sensing element configured to generate a signal indicative of a temperature of the sample. Likewise, some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein may include a pH sensing element configured to a signal indicative of a pH of the sample. Moreover, some embodiments disclosed herein may include both a temperature sensing element and a pH sensing element,
[0062] In some embodiments disclosed herein, a single element may be configured to sense both pH and analyte concentration. In certain embodiments, this analyte and pH sensing element may be configured to generate two signals, both of which are indicative of analyte concentration and pH. Thus, in certain embodiments, an analyte and pH sensing element may generate a first signal indicative of an analyte concentration of a sample and a pH of the sample, and also generate a second signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and the pH of the sample. Moreover, some embodiments including an analyte and pH sensing element may further include a temperature sensing element configured to generate a third signal which is indicative of a temperature of the sample.
[0063] In certain embodiments, the measurement devices disclosed herein may further include a receiving and processing unit. In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unity may be configured to transform a signal indicative of analyte concentration, which has been generated by an analyte sensing element. In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit may transform the signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, as described in detail below. In some embodiments, the values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based upon data which may include temperature calibration data and a signal indicative of temperature which has been generated by a temperature sensing element. In some embodiments, the values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based upon data which may include pH calibration data and a signal indicative of pH which has been generated by a pH sensing element. In some embodiments, the values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based upon data which may include temperature and pH calibration data, a signal indicative of temperature which has been generated by a temperature sensing element, and a signal indicative of pH which has been generated by a pH sensing element. In some embodiments, the signal indicative of analyte concentration— which is transformed by the receiving and processing unit— has been generated based upon data comprising two signals, each of which was generated by an analyte and pH sensing element, and each of which is indicative of analyte concentration and pH. These two signals may also be utilized to generate a signal indicative of pH which may be used with calibration data to set values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters.
[0064] Figures 1A through IE are flow charts illustrating the sensing mechanism corresponding to some embodiments of the measurement devices 100 disclosed herein. These flow charts may correspond to the sensing mechanism of an in vitro measurement device for use on the laboratory bench top, or they may correspond to the sensing mechanism of a device used for in vivo analyte sensing. As schematically illustrated in Figure 1A, some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein include at least one analyte sensing element 105, and may include at least one temperature sensing element 120. Other configurations of measurement devices, differing from the configuration illustrated in Figure 1A, are schematically illustrated in Figures IB through IE. Figure IB, for instance, schematically illustrates a measurement device 100 having an analyte sensing element 105 and a pH sensing element 121, but lacking the temperature sensing element 120 of the configuration illustrated in Figure 1A. Figure 1C schematically illustrates a measurement device 100 having a combination analyte and pH sensing element 1 10, instead of the distinct analyte and pH sensing elements as shown in Figure IB. Figure ID schematically illustrates a configuration having an analyte sensing element 105, a temperature sensing element 120, and a pH sensing element 121. Figure IE schematically illustrates a configuration having the combination analyte and pH sensing element 110 of Figure 1C along with a temperature sensing element 120. The analyte sensing element 105 may include at least one light source 111, at least one detector 115, and an indicator system 113. The indicator system 113 includes the sensing moieties— including at least one fluorophore and at least one binding moiety. In some embodiments, when the sensing moieties contact a sample containing the analyte of interest, a reversible, equilibrium-based, affinity-driven binding interaction between the analyte and the at least one binding moiety is established. This binding interaction alters the binding moiety's relationship with the fluorophore, such that when the fluorophore is excited by light from the at least one light source 1 1 1, its fluorescent emission is different depending on the extent to which analyte has been bound by the binding moiety. Thus, emission from the fluorophore is indicative of the concentration of analyte in the sample. In some embodiments, emission from the fluorophore may also be indicative of the pH of the sample. If this is the case, fluorescent emissions may be used to determine pH and analyte concentration as described in U.S. Application No. 11/671,880, entitled "Optical Determination of pH and Glucose," filed February 6, 2007, hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. Whether indicative of analyte concentration, pH, or both, the fluorescent emission generated by the fluorophore (and modulated by the binding moiety) is detected by the detector 1 15 which generates a signal indicative of the emission (and thus also the analyte concentration and/or the pH) which is passed to the receiving and processing unit 125. The receiving and processing unit 125 is configured to estimate the concentration of the analyte in the sample based on one or more signals indicative of analyte concentration— such as the intensities of the fluorescent emissions. In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit 125 may be further configured to generate temperature and/or pH corrected estimates of analyte concentration. The receiving and processing unit 125 may correct for temperature by receiving and taking into account one or more signals indicative of temperature generated by the temperature sensing element 120, as schematically illustrated in Figures 1A, ID, and IE. The receiving and processing unit 125 may correct for pH by receiving and taking into account one or more signals indicative of pH generated either by the pH sensing element 121, as schematically illustrated in Figures IB and ID, or by the analyte and pH sensing element 110. The receiving and processing unit 125 may employ various methods and algorithms of adjusting the estimated concentration based on the signal indicative of temperature, or the signal indicative of pH, or both, as described in further detail below. Estimated concentrations may be displayed in a display unit 126 and/or stored in a storage unit 127, as schematically illustrated in Figures 1A through IE. Depending on the embodiment, any quantity related to analyte concentration (such as quantities derived in whole or in part from measurements of optical intensity) may be displayed in the display unit 126 and/or stored in the storage unit 127, including, but not limited to the measured fluorescent intensities emitted by the fluorophores, the temperature of the sample, and the pH of the sample. In addition, as schematically illustrated in Figures 1 A through IE, some embodiments of the measurement device 100 include one or more filters 112 located between the light source 1 11 and indicator system 113, and/or one or more filters 1 14 located between the indicator system 1 13 and the detector 1 15. The filter 112 may serve to select particular wavelengths of light for excitation of the fluorophore, while the filter 1 14 may serve to select particular wavelengths of light for detection. Other optical components may also be utilized (that are not shown in Figures 1A through IE) including, but not limited to, mirrors, collimating and/or focusing lenses, beam splitters, etc. (See, e.g., Figures 2A, 2B, and 2C below.)
[0065] In some embodiments, the measurement device 100 may include a controller unit (not shown in Figures 1 A through IE) which controls various operations of the measurement device 100 including, but not limited to, control of the light sources, control of detectors, and responding to operator input or actions. The controller unit can be any type known in the art and capable of controlling the measuring device including, but not limited to, a microprocessor, an embedded processor, a multiprocessor, a general purpose computer, a special purpose processor, a microcontroller, a programmable gate array or any combination thereof.
Analyte Sensing Elements, pH Sensing Elements, and Analyte and pH Sensing Elements
[0066] Various measurement devices disclosed herein include an analyte sensing element or an element capable of sensing both analyte concentration and pH— referred to herein as an analyte and pH sensing element. The latter dual purpose elements are schematically illustrated, for example, in Figures 1C and IE. However, as indicated by Figures IB and ID, various embodiments of the measurement devices 100 disclosed herein may include an analyte sensing element 105, and a pH sensing element 121 separate from the analyte sensing element 105. When the pH sensing element 121 is distinct from the analyte sensing element 105, it may consist of any of a number of standard pH sensing devices which are known in the art so long as the device is properly sized and is capable of generating a signal indicative of pH which exhibits sufficient accuracy and precision to serve as a basis for applying pH correction to a signal indicative of analyte concentration. Of course, in measurement devices 100 that do not implement pH correction, such as those corresponding to the schematic illustration of Figure 1A, a pH sensing element is not needed for this purpose and may be omitted.
[0067] An analyte sensing element may be configured to generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of a sample and may include at least one light source, an indicator system, and at least one detector. In some embodiments, the indicator system (described more fully below) may include at least one type of fluorophore and at least one type of binding moiety (each described in greater detail below), and in some embodiments, an immobilizing medium whose presence may prevent some of the fluorophores and/or some of the binding moieties from freely diffusing through the sample (as described in greater detail below). In some embodiments, the fluorophore emits a fluorescence having an intensity in response to light from the at least one light source. In some embodiments, the binding moiety is capable of binding the analyte and is operably coupled to the fluorophore, such that when the sample contacts the binding moiety the intensity is indicative of the concentration of the analyte. In some embodiments, the analyte sensing element includes at least one detector which may be configured to detect the intensity and generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample in response to the intensity.
[0068] Likewise, a dual purpose, analyte and pH sensing element may be configured to generate one or more signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a sample and the pH of the sample. In some embodiments, an analyte and pH sensing element may include at least one light source, an indicator system, and at least one detector, similarly to the analyte sensing elements described in the preceding paragraph. Thus, in some embodiments, the indicator system (described more fully below) may include at least one type of fluorophore and at least one type of binding moiety (each described in greater detail below), and in some embodiments, an immobilizing medium whose presence may prevent some of the fluorophores and/or some of the binding moieties from freely diffusing through the sample (as described in greater detail below). In some embodiments, the fluorophore emits a fluorescence having an intensity in response to light from the at least one light source. In some embodiments, the binding moiety is capable of binding the analyte and is operably coupled to the fluorophore, such that when the sample contacts the binding moiety the intensity is indicative of the concentration of analyte in the sample and the pH of the sample. In some embodiments, the analyte and pH sensing element includes at least one detector which may be configured to detect the intensity and generate one or more signals indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and the pH of the sample in response to the intensity.
[0069] Some of the measurement devices disclosed herein, only employ a single type of fluorophore and a single light source. However, it should be understood that some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein employ more than one type of fluorophore. Furthermore, some embodiments of measurement devices employing multiple types of fluorophores may also employ more than one light source. Similarly, embodiments employing more than one type of fluorophore may also employ more than one detector. In certain such embodiments, the single detector may be a spectrometer. [0070] However, dual light source and dual detector configurations are not necessarily limited to configurations utilizing multiple fluorophores, as these dual light source/detector configurations may offer other advantages. For instance, a dual light source configuration might advantageously allow one light source to serve as a reference for the other, or a dual light source configuration might be useful for measurement devices employing ratiometric pH determination as disclosed in U.S. Patent No. 7,751,863, entitled "Optical Determination of pH and Glucose," which is hereby incorporated herein by reference in its entirety. Methods and/or algorithms for determining pH based on the ratio of two fluorescent emission signals are discussed below, as well as described in the aforementioned patent. In some embodiments, these methods may be implemented in a measurement device employing a combination analyte and pH sensing element which utilizes a dual light source configuration, as described below with reference to Figures 2A through 2C.
[0071] Accordingly, embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein may configure light sources, detectors, and one or more fluorophores and binding moieties in a variety of ways. For example, Figure 2A schematically illustrates a two light source measurement device in accordance with certain preferred embodiments of the present invention. With reference to Figure 2A, the two light sources, 301A and 301B, each generate excitation light. In some embodiments, each of the two light sources 301 A and 30 IB generates excitation light over a different range of wavelengths. In certain such embodiments, the excitation light generated by light source 301A falls within a wavelength range appropriate to cause an emission of a first type, and the excitation light generated by light source 30 IB falls within a wavelength range appropriate to cause an emission of a second type. In some embodiments, the ranges are partially overlapping, while in other embodiments, the ranges are fully non-overlapping.
[0072] The excitation light generated by light sources 301A and 301B may be transmitted (as illustrated) through collimator lenses 302A and 302B. The collimator lenses 302A and 302B may be aspheric lenses, but other types of collimator lenses may also be employed.
[0073] In certain embodiments, light exiting from the collimator lenses 302A and 302B may be transmitted (as illustrated) to interference filters 303A and 303B. In some embodiments, each interference filter 303A and 303B may attenuate or block a portion of the wavelength ranges generated by light sources other than the corresponding light source 301 A and 301B. For instance, in certain such embodiments, interference filter 303A may pass light generated by light source 301A, but may severely attenuate light generated by light source 301B. Interference filter 303B may function analogously. In certain embodiments, each interference filter 303A and 303B blocks the wavelength range that overlaps with the wavelength range corresponding to emission by the one or more types of fluorophores. For example, if a measurement system employs a blue excitation light to produce a green emission, then an interference filter may in some embodiments preferably be used to narrow the band of blue excitation, because the blue excitation light may comprise both blue and green light. An unfiltered excitation blue that comprises green light can produce inaccurate green emission signal because the green light from the excitation light will add to the green emission signal of the fluorophore to produce a green light of greater intensity.
[0074] The interference filters 303A and 303B can be short or long pass filters that block all wavelengths beyond a certain maximum or minimum wavelength. The interference filters 303A and 303B can be band pass filters that only allow a particular band of wavelengths to pass through the filters. In certain embodiments, the measurement device employs interference filters 303A and 303B that are band pass filters because, in certain embodiments, the light sources 301A and 301B generate light of overlapping wavelength ranges. Thus, the use of non-overlapping band pass filters 303A and 303B may allow the measurement device to generate excitation light in distinct bands such that light generated by the light source 301 A selectively creates only excitation of a first type, and light generated by 30 IB selectively creates only excitation of a second type. In this manner, in some embodiments, each light source may be tailored to create a particular type of emission.
[0075] In certain embodiments, light exiting from interference filters 303A and 303B may be focused (as illustrated) by focusing lenses 304A and 304B into fiber optic lines 305A and 305B. The fiber optic lines 305A and 305B carry the filtered excitation light to the indicator system 307, which is contained within a sensor probe 200. In some embodiments, the sensor probe 200 includes a protective housing 500 which serves to protect the indicator system 307 contained within the sensor probe 200. In some embodiments, the indicator system is immobilized in an immobilizing medium within the sensor probe 200, as described herein. In some embodiments, the fiber optic lines 305A and 305B merge into a single fiber 306 that is continuous with the sensor probe 200. In other embodiments, the fiber optic lines 305A and 305B remain distinct (although not shown in Figure 2A). In certain embodiments employing two types of fluorophores, the fiber optic lines 305A and 305B may remain distinct and be configured so as to keep the two types of fluorophores spatially distinct/separated so that each type of fluorophore may only interact with light traveling to the indicator system down a single optical fiber (that is light generated from one of the light sources). In certain other embodiments, the fiber optic lines 305A and 305B may be kept distinct so that one line may be configured so that light traveling down the line never interacts with any fluorophore— in this manner creating a reference signal and keeping it free from optical contamination by the optically emitting fluorophore interacting with light travelling down the other fiber optic line. The cross-sections of the fibers may vary (as illustrated) from a bundle of fibers surrounding a central optical fiber 306A to a single fiber 306B.
[0076] The indicator system 307 contained within the sensor probe 200 responds to the excitation light by emitting light (as described in detail herein). In certain embodiments (as illustrated in Figure 2A), the emission light signals generated by the indicator system 307 as well as the excitation light signals are transmitted back out of the sensor probe 200 into the fiber optic outlet lines 309A and 309B. In some embodiments, each fiber optic outlet line 309A and 309B substantially carries light corresponding to one type of fluorescent emission. For example, outlet line 309A carries light away from the sensor probe 200 substantially consisting of a first type of fluorescent emission, and outlet line 309B carries light away from the sensor probe 200 substantially consisting of a second type of fluorescent emission. In measuring devices configured with a mirror 308 beyond the indicator system 307 at the far end of the sensor probe 200 (such as shown in Figure 2A), a portion of the light transmitted back out of the sensor probe 200 into the fiber optic outlet lines 309A and 309B is light that has been reflected by the mirror 308. However, other embodiments may lack a mirror.
[0077] In the measurement device schematically illustrated in Figure 2A, the fiber optic outlet lines 309A and 309B are augmented by including two interference filters 312A and 312B; and two detectors 313A and 313B. In certain embodiments, the interference filter 312A is configured to substantially block the excitation light generated by light source 301A (and, in some embodiments, additionally block the excitation and emission/fluorescence wavelengths corresponding to light source 30 IB) and substantially pass the fluorescence emitted and generated by the indicator system in response to irradiation by light source 301A. As a result, this fluorescence passes to detector 313A where it is detected. The detector 313A may be any device capable of measuring fluorescent intensity at an appropriate wavelength or over an appropriate range of wavelengths, including, but not limited to, detectors consisting of one or more photodiodes. In certain embodiments, the detector 313A produces a signal that is amplified by the amplifier 314A and converted into a digital signal by analog-to-digital converter 315A and transmitted to a receiving and processing unit 316. The receiving and processing unit 316 may comprise a data processing device of any type known in the art, for example, a microprocessor, an embedded processor, a multiprocessor, a general purpose computer, a special purpose processor, any computational device, a digital signal processor, a microcontroller, a programmable gate array or any combination thereof.
[0078] The interference filter 312B, detector 313B, amplifier 314B, and analog-to- digital converter 315B may function in a similar manner with respect to fluorescence emitted and generated by the indicator system 307 in response to irradiation by light source 301B. In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit 316, after receiving digital signals from the analog-to-digital converters 315A and 315B may employ various calculation schemes disclosed herein to estimate an analyte concentration, and in some embodiments, the glucose concentration of a sample. In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit 316 may employ a temperature correction and/or pH correction method or algorithm such as those described in detail below. In addition, in some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit 316 may transmit data and/or results to a storage unit which may store the data and/or results (e.g. on an optical or magnetic disc or other digital medium). In some embodiments, the receiving and processing unit 316 may transmit data and/or results to a display unit which may display the data and/or results (e.g. on a print-out or display screen).
[0079] Another embodiment of an measurement device is schematically illustrated in Figure 2B. Like the device schematically illustrated in Figure 2A, the device depicted in Figure 2B is a two light source measurement device. However, the device depicted in Figure 2B differs from that depicted in Figure 2A in that it utilizes a spectrophotometer 310 instead of the multiple detectors 312A and 312B shown in Figure 2A. In some embodiments, the spectrophotometer may be a ultraviolet/visible microspectrometer such as those manufactured by Boehringer Ingelheim or Ocean Optic Inc. However, in principle, any spectrophotometer which measures optical intensity over the appropriate wavelength range(s) may be used. [0080] As schematically illustrated in Figure 2B, the spectrophotometer 310 receives light from the indicator system 307 via a single fiber optic outlet line 309. In some embodiments, a spectrophotometer 310 such as that depicted in Figure 2B is capable of measuring optical intensity over a broader range of wavelengths than the detectors 312A and 312B. Accordingly, in some embodiments, one spectrophotometer 310 fed by a single optical fiber 309 may provide the detection functionality of multiple detectors and in some embodiments much more flexibility. However, in some embodiments there are other device design tradeoffs such as, for example, potential cost, complexity, size, and power requirements.
[0081] Also absent from the measurement device depicted in Figure 2B are the filters 312A and 312B; the amplifiers 314A and 314B; and the analog-to-digital converters 315A and 315B exhibited by the device schematically illustrated in Figure 2A. Similar functionality is provided, in some embodiments, by the spectrophotometer 310 itself. The spectrophotometer 310 transmits data and/or results to a receiving and processing unit 316 as was described in reference to Figure 2A. The receiving and processing units 316 of Figures 2A and 2B may function similarly, as described above, depending on the embodiment.
[0082] Yet another embodiment of an analyte measuring device is schematically illustrated in Figure 2C. Like the devices schematically illustrated in Figures 2A, and 2B, the device depicted in Figure 2C is a two light source measurement device. However, the device depicted in Figure 2C utilizes a single fiber optic outlet line 309 which transmits light to a single collimator lens 317 and then on to beam splitters 318. In some embodiments, the beam splitter 318 substantially reflects light generated by a first type of fluorescent emission, and substantially transmits light generated by a second type of fluorescent emission. The reflected light is transmitted to a detector 313A, which generates an analogue signal indicative of the intensity of the reflected light. The signal is amplified by the amplifier 314A and transmitted to the analog- to-digital converter 315A where it is digitized. The digital signal is then transmitted to the receiving and processing unit 316. Light transmitted by the beam splitter 318 is detected by the detector 313B, amplified by the amplifier 314B, digitized by the analog-to-digital converter 315B, and transmitted to the receiving and processing unit 316 in parallel fashion to the light reflected by the beam splitter 318. As described above, the receiving and processing unit 316 may be a data processing device of any type known in the art, for example, a microprocessor, an embedded processor, a multiprocessor, a general purpose computer, a special purpose processor, any computational device, a digital signal processor, a microcontroller, a programmable gate array or any combination thereof.
[0083] The beam splitter 318 may be an interference filter designed to work at a substantially forty-five degree angle, as shown in Figure 2C. In certain embodiments, the beam splitter 318 comprises a glass surface with a coating that reflects light having a certain wavelength and transmits all other light. The beam splitter 318 can be positioned at a substantially forty-five degree angle relative the direction of the light traveling from the collimator lens 317. As described above, in some embodiments, the beam splitter 318 is configured in such a way that light generated by different types of fluorescent emission are detected separately by a dedicated detector 313A and 313B.
[0084] Notably absent from the embodiment schematically depicted in Figure 2C versus that depicted in Figure 2B are the filters 312A and 312B. In certain embodiments employing a beam splitter 318 renders additional filtering by the dedicated filters 312A and 312B unnecessary. Multiple fiber optic outlets lines may also be superfluous when a beam splitter is employed as is apparent from comparing the embodiments schematically illustrated in Figure 2A (utilizing fiber optic outlet lines 309A and 309B) and Figure 2C (utilizing a single line 309). However, there are design trade-offs between the embodiments schematically illustrated in all three Figures 2A, 2B, and 2C as appreciated by one skilled in the art. Moreover, the embodiments illustrated in Figures 2A, 2B, and 2C are merely illustrative of the types of device configurations which are possible. These example embodiments are not meant to be exhaustive and the particular design chosen is not necessarily critical to the working of the various measurement devices disclosed herein.
Temperature Sensing Elements
[0085] In addition to an analyte sensing element, a pH sensing element, or a combination analyte and pH sensing element, the measurement device may contain a temperature sensing element, such as, for example, a thermistor or a thermocouple, located within the sensor probe 200. In some embodiments, the temperature sensing element is located at or near the analyte sensing chemistry (i.e. the indicator system) such that the temperature being measured is characteristic of the temperature of the analyte solution where the concentration is being measured. In some embodiments, the temperature sensing element may be co-located with the indicator system within a distal tip of the sensor probe. A suitable temperature sensing element is preferably small enough such that the sensor probe 200 does not have to be increased in size substantially to accommodate it.
[0086] The temperature sensing element is particularly important when the analyte sensing chemistry, such as a fluorophore system, is affected by temperature change. As described above and in greater detail below, in some embodiments, the fluorescence intensity emitted by the fluorophore system is dependent on the temperature of the fluorophore system. By measuring the temperature of the fluorophore system, temperature induced variations in fluorophore fluorescence intensity can be accounted for, allowing for more accurate determination of analyte concentration, as more fully described below. For example, a fluorophore based glucose sensing chemistry may generate signals indicative of glucose concentration which are effected by the temperature at which the sensing is performed, and knowledge of the effect of temperature on these signals may be used to generate estimates of glucose concentration which are corrected for temperature.
Sensor Probe
[0087] Figure 3 illustrates in greater detail a sensor probe 200 in accordance with an embodiment of the present invention. The sensor probe 200 comprises an optical fiber 10 with a distal end 12 disposed in a porous membrane sheath 14. The optical fiber 10 has cavities, such as holes 6A, in the fiber optic wall that can be formed by, for example, mechanical means such as drilling or cutting. The holes 6A in the optical fiber 10 can be filled with a suitable compound, such as a polymer. In some embodiments, the polymer is a hydrogel 8. In other embodiments of the sensor probe 200 as shown in Figure 4, the optical fiber 10 does not have holes 6A, and instead, the hydrogel 8 is disposed in a space distal to the distal end 12 of the optical fiber 10 and proximal to the mirror 23. In some embodiments, the sensor probe 200 is configured to generate a signal indicative of glucose concentration. In some embodiments, the sensor probe 200 is configured for intravascular deployment.
[0088] In some embodiments, the porous membrane sheath 14 can be made from a polymeric material such as polyethylene, polycarbonate, polysulfone or polypropylene. Other materials can also be used to make the porous membrane sheath 14 such as zeolites, ceramics, metals, or combinations of these materials. In some embodiments, the porous membrane sheath 14 may be nanoporous. In other embodiments, the porous membrane sheath 14 may be microporous. In still other embodiments, the porous membrane sheath 14 may be mesoporous. [0089] In some embodiments as shown in Figure 4, the porous membrane sheath 14 is attached to the optical fiber 10 by a connector 16. For example, the connector 16 can be an elastic collar that holds the porous membrane sheath 14 in place by exerting a compressive force on the optical fiber 10, as shown in Figure 4. In other embodiments, the connector 16 is an adhesive or a thermal weld.
[0090] In some embodiments, such as that shown in Figure 3, a mirror 23 and a temperature sensing element such as a thermistor 25 may be placed within the porous membrane sheath 14 distal the distal end 12 of the optical fiber 10. Thermistor leads 27 can be made to run in a space between the optical fiber 10 and porous membrane sheath 14. Although a thermistor 25 is shown, other devices such as a thermocouple, pressure transducer, an oxygen sensor, a carbon dioxide sensor or a pH sensor for example can be used instead.
[0091] In some embodiments as shown in Figure 4, the distal end 18 of the porous membrane sheath 14 is open and can be sealed with, for example, an adhesive 20. In some embodiments, the adhesive 20 can comprise a polymerizable material that can fill the distal end 18 and then be polymerized into a plug. Alternatively, in other embodiments the distal end 18 can be thermally welded by melting a portion of the polymeric material on the distal end 18, closing the opening and allowing the melted polymeric material to resolidify. In other embodiments as shown in Figure 3, a polymeric plug 21 can be inserted into the distal end 18 and thermally heated to weld the plug to the porous membrane sheath 14. Thermoplastic polymeric materials such as polyethylene, polypropylene, polycarbonate and polysulfone are particularly suited for thermal welding. In other embodiments, the distal end 18 of the porous membrane sheath 14 can be sealed against the optical fiber 10.
[0092] After the porous membrane sheath 14 is attached to the optical fiber 10 and the distal end 18 of the porous membrane sheath 14 is sealed, the sensor probe 200 can be vacuum filled with a first solution comprising a monomer, a crosslinker and a first initiator. Vacuum filling of a polymerizable solution through a porous membrane and into a cavity in a sensor is described in detail in US Patent No. 5,618,587 to Markle et al.; incorporated herein in its entirety by reference thereto. The first solution is allowed to fill the cavity 6 within the optical fiber 10.
[0093] In some embodiments, the first solution is aqueous and the monomer, the crosslinker and the first initiator are soluble in water. For example, in some embodiments, the monomer is acrylamide, the crosslinker is bisacrylamide and the first initiator is ammonium persulfate. In other embodiments, the monomer is dimethylacrylamide or N- hydroxymethylacrylamide. By increasing the concentrations of the monomer and/or crosslinker, the porosity of the resulting gel can be decreased. Conversely, by decreasing the concentrations of the monomer and/or crosslinker, the porosity of the resulting gel can be increased. Other types of monomers and crosslinkers are also contemplated. In other embodiments, the first solution further comprises an analyte indicator system comprising a fluorophore and an analyte binding moiety that functions to quench the fluorescent emission of the fluorophore by an amount related to the concentration of the analyte. In some embodiments, the fluorophore and analyte binding moiety are immobilized during polymerization, such that the fluorophore and analyte binding moiety are operably coupled. In other embodiments, the fluorophore and analyte binding moiety are covalently linked. The indicator system chemistry may also be covalently linked to the polymeric matrix.
[0094] In some embodiments, after the sensor probe 200 is filled with the first solution, the optical fiber 10 and the first solution filled porous membrane sheath 14 and cavity 6 are transferred to and immersed into a second solution comprising a second initiator. In some embodiments, the second solution is aqueous and the second initiator is tetramethylethylenediamine (TEMED). In some embodiments, the second solution further comprises the same fluorescent dye and/or quencher found in the first solution and in substantially the same concentrations. By having the fluorescent dye and quencher in both the first solution and the second solution, diffusion of fluorescent dye and quencher out of the first solution and into the second solution can be reduced. In some embodiments where a second solution is used, the second solution further comprises monomer in substantially the same concentration as in the first solution. This reduces diffusion of monomer out of the first solution by reducing the monomer gradient between the first solution and the second solution.
[0095] In some embodiments, at or approximately at the interface between the first and second solutions, the first initiator and the second initiator can react together to generate a radical. In some embodiments, the first initiator and the second initiator react together in a redox reaction. In other embodiments, the radical can be generated by thermal decomposition, photolytic initiation or initiation by ionizing radiation. In these other embodiments, the radical may be generated anywhere in the first solution. Once the radical is generated, the radical can then initiate polymerization of the monomer and crosslinker in the first solution.
[0096] When the radical is generated via a redox reaction as described herein, the polymerization proceeds generally from the interface between the first and second solutions to the interior of the porous membrane sheath 14 and towards the cavity in the optical fiber 10. Rapid initiation of polymerization can help reduce the amount of first initiator that can diffuse from the first solution and into the second solution. Reducing the amount of first initiator that diffuses out of the first solution helps reduce polymerization of monomer outside the porous membrane sheath 14 which helps in forming a smooth external surface. Polymerization of the monomer and crosslinker results in a hydrogel 8 that in some embodiments substantially immobilizes the indicator system, forming the sensor probe 200. Further variations on polymerization methodologies are disclosed in U.S. Patent Publ. No. 2008/0187655; incorporated herein in its entirety by reference thereto.
[0097] With reference to Figure 5A, in certain embodiments, the sensor probe 200 is a solid optical fiber with a series holes 6A drilled straight through the sides of the optical fiber. In certain embodiments, the holes 6A are filled with the hydrogels 8. In certain embodiments, the series of holes 6A that are drilled through the sensor probe 200 are evenly spaced horizontally and evenly rotated around the sides of the sensor probe 200 to form a spiral or helical configuration. In certain embodiments, the series of holes 6A are drilled through the diameter of the sensor probe 200. With reference to Figure 5B, in certain embodiments, the sensor probe 200 is a solid optical fiber with a series of holes 6A drilled through the sides of the fiber at an angle. In certain embodiments, the series of holes 6A drilled at an angle, which are filled with hydrogel 8, are evenly spaced horizontally and evenly rotated around the sides the sensor probe 200. With reference to Figure 5C, in certain embodiments, the optical fiber comprises a groove 6B along the length of the optical fiber, wherein the groove 6B is filled with hydrogel 8. In certain embodiments, the depth of the groove 6B extends to the center of the optical fiber. In certain embodiments, the groove 6B spirals around the optical fiber. In certain embodiments, the groove 6B spirals around the optical fiber to complete at least one rotation. In certain embodiments, the groove spirals 6B around the optical fiber to complete multiple rotations around the optical fiber. [0098] With reference to Figure 5D, in certain embodiments, the sensor probe 200 is a solid optical fiber with triangular wedges 6C cut from the fiber. In certain embodiments, the triangular wedge areas 6C are filled with hydrogel 8. In certain embodiments, the triangular wedges cut-outs 6C are evenly spaced horizontally and around the sides of the sensor probe 200. In certain embodiments, all light traveling in the sensor probe 200 is transmitted through at least one hole 6A or groove 6B filled with hydrogel 8.
[0099] In certain embodiments, as illustrated in Figure 6, the sensor probe 200 comprises an optical fiber 10 having a distal end 12, an atraumatic tip portion 134 having a proximal end 136 and a distal end 138, a cavity 6 between the distal end 12 of the optical fiber 10 and the proximal end 136 of the atraumatic tip portion 134, and a rod 140 connecting the distal end 12 of the optical fiber 10 to the proximal end 136 of the atraumatic tip portion 134. A hydrogel 8 containing the sensing chemistry, for example a fluorophore and quencher, fills the cavity 6. Also present within the cavity 6 is a temperature sensing element 25, such as thermocouple or thermistor. Covering the hydrogel filled cavity 6 is a selectively permeable membrane 14 that allows passage of the analyte being detected/sensed into and out of the hydrogel 8. It should, of course, be understood that the sensor probe 200 may be modified to generate signals indicative of the analyte concentration of various analytes by selecting, for example, an appropriate sensing chemistry, and if necessary, choosing an appropriate selectively permeable membrane 14.
[0100] The proximal portion of the sensor probe 200 comprises the proximal portion of the optical fiber 10. In some embodiments, the diameter, Dl, of the distal portion of the sensor 2 is greater than the diameter, D2, of the proximal portion of the sensor 2. For example, the diameter Dl of the distal portion of the sensor probe 200 can be between about 0.0080 inches and 0.020 inches, while the diameter D2 of the proximal portion of the sensor probe 200 can be between about 0.005 inches to 0.015 inches. In some embodiments, the diameter Dl of the distal portion of the sensor probe 200 is about 0.012 inches, while the diameter D2 of the proximal portion of the sensor probe 200 is about 0.010 inches.
Indicator Systems
[0101] The indicator system includes the sensing moieties— including, in some embodiments, at least one type of fluorophore and at least one type of binding moiety. In some embodiments, when the sensing moieties contact a sample containing the analyte of interest, a reversible, equilibrium-based, affinity-driven binding interaction between the analyte and the at least one type of binding moiety is established. This binding interaction alters the binding moieties' relationship with the fiuorophores, such that when the fluorophores are excited by light from the at least one light source, their fluorescent emission varies with the extent to which analyte has been bound by the binding moieties. Thus, emission from the one or more types of fluorophores is indicative of the concentration of analyte in the sample.
[0102] Accordingly, in some embodiments the indicator system includes at least one type of fluorophore which emits a fluorescence having an intensity in response to light from at least one light source. In certain such embodiments, the intensity is detectable by at least one detector. The indicator system further includes at least one type of binding moiety capable of binding the analyte. The at least one type of binding moiety is typically operably coupled to the at least one type of fluorophore such that when the sample contacts the at least one type of binding moiety the intensity (emitted in response to light from the at least one light source, as described above) is indicative of the concentration of the analyte. For example, a glucose binding moiety such as 3,3'-oBBV (described in detail below) that is coupled to a fluorescent dye such as HPTS-triLysMA (described in detail below) will quench the emission intensity of the fluorescent dye, wherein the extent of quenching is reduced upon glucose binding resulting in an increase in emission intensity related to glucose concentration. In some embodiments, the indicator system may include an immobilizing medium configured to prevent some of the fluorophores and/or some of the binding moieties from freely diffusing through the sample. Fluorophores
[0103] "Fluorophore" refers to a substance that when illuminated by light at a particular wavelength emits light at a longer wavelength; i.e. it fluoresces. Fluorophores include but are not limited to organic dyes, organometallic compounds, metal chelates, fluorescent conjugated polymers, quantum dots or nanoparticles and combinations of the above. Fluorophores may be discrete moieties or substituents attached to a polymer.
[0104] Fluorophores that may be used in preferred embodiments are capable of being excited by light of wavelength at or greater than about 400 nm, with a Stokes shift large enough that the excitation and emission wavelengths are separable by at least 10 nm. In some embodiments, the separation between the excitation and emission wavelengths may be equal to or greater than about 30 nm. These fluorophores are preferably susceptible to quenching by electron acceptor molecules, such as viologens, and are resistant to photo-bleaching. They are also preferably stable against photo-oxidation, hydrolysis and biodegradation.
[0105] In some embodiments, the fluorophore may be a discrete compound.
[0106] In some embodiments, the fluorophore may be a pendant group or a chain unit in a water-soluble or water-dispersible polymer having molecular weight of about 10,000 Daltons or greater, forming a dye-polymer unit. In one embodiment, such dye-polymer unit may also be non-covalently associated with a water-insoluble polymer matrix M1 and is physically immobilized within the polymer matrix M1, wherein M1 is permeable to or in contact with analyte solution. In another embodiment, the dye on the dye-polymer unit may be negatively charged, and the dye-polymer unit may be immobilized as a complex with a cationic water- soluble polymer, wherein said complex is permeable to or in contact with the analyte solution. In one embodiment, the dye may be one of the polymeric derivatives of hydroxypyrene trisulfonic acid. The polymeric dyes may be water-soluble, water-swellable or dispersible in water. In some embodiments, the polymeric dyes may also be cross-linked. In preferred embodiments, the dye has a negative charge.
[0107] In other embodiments, the dye molecule may be covalently bonded to the water-insoluble polymer matrix M1, wherein said M1 is permeable to or in contact with the analyte solution. The dye molecule bonded to M1 may form a structure M'-L'-Dye. L1 is a hydrolytically stable covalent linker that covalently connects the sensing moiety to the polymer or matrix. Examples of L1 include lower alkylene (e.g., CrC8 alkylene), optionally terminated with or interrupted by one or more divalent connecting groups selected from sulfonamide (— S02NH-), amide ~(C=0)N--, ester -(C=0)~0-, ether.-O--, sulfide ~S~, sulfone (~S02~), phenylene ~C6H4~, urethane -NH(C=0)-0-, urea -NH(C=0)NH-, thiourea -NH(C=S)- ΝΗ--, amide ~(C=0)NH~, amine --NR-- (where R is defined as alkyl having 1 to 6 carbon atoms) and the like, or a combination thereof. In one embodiment, the dye is bonded to a polymer matrix through the sulfonamide functional groups.
[0108] In some embodiments, useful dyes include pyranine derivatives (e.g. hydroxypyrene trisulfonamide derivatives and the like), which have the following formula: [0109] wherein R1, R2, R
Figure imgf000031_0001
wherein X1 is -OH, -OCH3COOH, -CONH2, -S03H, -NH2, or OMe; and n is between about 70 and 10,000. In one embodiment, the dyes may be bonded to a polymer through the sulfonamide functional groups. In other embodiments, the dye may be one of the polymeric derivatives of hydroxypyrene trisulfonic acid. In some embodiments, the fluorescent dye may be 8- hydroxypyrene-l,3,6-trisulfonate (HPTS). The counter-ions can be H+, Na+, or any other cation. HPTS has a molecular weight of less than 500 Daltons, so it will not stay within the polymer matrix, but it can be used with an anion exclusion membrane. The dyes may be used with a quencher comprising boronic acid, such as 3,3'-oBBV.
Figure imgf000031_0002
(the Na+ salt of HPTS— "pyranine")
[0110] In some embodiments, dyes of the following generic structure may serve as suitable fluorophores:
Figure imgf000031_0003
wherein: » —C-R4
R is H :
-(CH2)N -A-M+,
wherein n is 1-4,
wherein A" is an anionic group selected from the group consisting of S03 ", HP03 ", C02
Figure imgf000032_0001
and
wherein M* is a cationic group selected from the group consisting of ΗΓ1", an alkali metal ion, Li+, Na+, K+, Rb+, Cs+, Fr+, an onium ion and NR "1", wherein R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkylaryl and aromatic groups);
O
R4 is—C-R5;
5 Y-(CH2)-R6 Y^(C H2) -O )-|CH2-}-R6
R is selected from the group consisting of n and n n n ; wherein n is equal to 1-10, n' is equal to 2-4 and Y is selected from the group consisting of NH and O;
R6 is selected from the group consisting of NHR7, OR7 and C02H; and
R7 is H or an ethylenically unsaturated group selected from the group consisting of methacryloyl, acryloyl, styryl, acrylamide and methacrylamido.
[0111] In some embodiments, dyes of the following generic structure may serve as suitable fluorophores:
Figure imgf000032_0002
where:
R3 is— (CH2)n— A"M+
wherein n is 1 wherein A" is an anionic group selected from the group consisting of S03 ", HP03
Figure imgf000033_0001
and
wherein W is a cationic group selected from the group consisting of ΗΓ1", an alkali metal ion, Li+, Na+, K+, Rb+, Cs+, Fr+, an onium ion and NR4 ", wherein R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkylaryl and aromatic groups);
O
R4 is— C-R5;
R is selected from the group consisting of
Figure imgf000033_0002
wherein n is equal to 1-10, n' is equal to 2-4;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of NHR10, OR10 and C02H; and
R10 is H or an ethylenically unsaturated group selected from the group consisting of methacryloyl, acryloyl, styryl, acrylamido and methacrylamido.
[0112] In another embodiment, the fluorescent dye may be polymers of 8-acetoxy- pyrene-l,3,6-N, N',N"-tris-(methacrylpropylamidosulfonamide) (acetoxy-HPTS-MA):
Figure imgf000033_0003
[0113] It is noted that dyes such as acetoxy-HPTS-MA (above) having no anionic groups, may not give very strong glucose response when operably coupled to a viologen quencher, particularly a viologen quencher having only a single boronic acid moiety.
[0114] In another embodiment, the fluorescent dye may be 8-hydroxy-pyrene- 1,3,6- N, N',N"-tris-(carboxypropylsulfonamide) (HPTS-C02):
Figure imgf000034_0001
[0115] In another embodiment, the fluorescent dye may be 8-hydroxy-pyrene- 1,3,6- N, N',N"-tris-(methoxypolyethoxyethyl (-125) sulfonamide) (HPTS-PEG):
Figure imgf000034_0002
[0116] It is noted that dyes such as HPTS-PEG (above) having no anionic groups, may not provide a very strong glucose response when operably coupled to a viologen quencher, particularly a viologen quencher having only a single boronic acid moiety.
[0117] Representative dyes as discrete compounds are the tris adducts formed by reacting 8-acetoxypyrene-l,3,6-trisulfonyl chloride (HPTS-Cl) with an amino acid, such as amino butyric acid. Hydroxypyrene trisulfonamide dyes bonded to a polymer and bearing one or more anionic groups are most preferred, such as copolymers of 8-hydroxypyrene-l-N- (methacrylamidopropylsulfonamido)-N',N"-3,6-bis(carboxypropylsulfonamide) HPTS-C02-MA with HEMA, PEGMA, and the like.
[0118] In another embodiment, the fluorescent dye may be HPTS-TriCys-MA:
Figure imgf000035_0001
[0119] This dye is also referred to as just HPTS-Cys-MA. The dye may be used with a quencher comprising boronic acid, such as 3,3'-oBBV.
[0120] Of course, in some embodiments, substitutions other than Cys-MA on the HPTS core are consistent with aspects of the present invention, as long as the substitutions are negatively charged and have a polymerizable group. Either L or D stereoisomers of cysteine may be used. In some embodiments, only one or two of the sulfonic acids may be substituted. Likewise, in variations to HPTS-CysMA shown above, other counter-ions besides NBu4 + may be used, including positively charged metals, e.g., Na+. In other variations, the sulfonic acid groups may be replaced with e.g., phosphoric, carboxylic, etc. functional groups.
[0121] Another suitable dye is HPTS-LysMA, which is pictured below as follows:
Figure imgf000035_0002
[0122] Other examples include soluble copolymers of 8-acetoxypyrene-l,3,6-N, N', N"-tris(methacrylamidopropylsulfonamide) with HEMA, PEGMA, or other hydrophilic comonomers. The phenolic substituent in the dye is protected during polymerization by a blocking group that can be removed by hydrolysis after completion of polymerization. Such suitable blocking groups, as for example, acetoxy, trifluoroacetoxy, and the like, are well known in the art.
[0123] Fluorescent dyes, including HPTS and its derivatives are known and many have been used in analyte detection. See e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,653,141, 6,627,177, 5,512,246, 5,137,833, 6,800,451, 6,794,195, 6,804,544, 6,002,954, 6,319,540, 6,766,183, 5,503,770, and 5,763,238; and co-pending U.S. Patent Application Nos. 11/296,898, 60/833,081, and 1 1/671,880; each of which is incorporated herein in its entirety by reference thereto.
[0124] The SNARF and SNAFL dyes from Molecular Probes may also be useful fluorophores in accordance with aspects of the present invention. The structures of SNARF-1 and SNAFL- 1 are shown below.
Figure imgf000036_0001
SNARF-1 SNAFL-1
[0125] Additionally, a set of isomeric water-soluble fluorescent probes based on both the 6-aminoquinolinium and boronic acid moieties which show spectral shifts and intensity changes with pH, in a wavelength-ratiometric and colorimetric manner may be useful in accordance with some embodiments of the present invention (See e.g., Badugu, R. et al. 2005 Talanta 65 (3):762-768; and Badugu, R. et al. 2005 Bioorg. Med. Chem. 13 (1):113-119); incorporated herein in its entirety by reference.
[0126] Another example of a fluorescence dye is tetrakis(4-sulfophenyl)porphine (TSPP)— shown below. TSPP may not work optimally in blood, where the porphyrin ring may react with certain metal ions, like ferric, and become non-fluorescent. However, it may work better when included in the indicator system of a bench top analyte measurement apparatus.
Figure imgf000037_0001
(TSPP)
[0127] Other examples of fluorescent indicators that may be useful for determination of glucose concentration are described in US 2005/0233465 and US 2005/0090014; each of which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
Analyte Binding Moieties— Quenchers
[0128] In accordance with broad aspects of the present invention, the analyte binding moiety provides the at least dual functionality of being able to bind analyte and being able to modulate the apparent concentration of the fluorophore (e.g., detected as a change in emission signal intensity) in a manner related to the amount of analyte binding. In preferred embodiments, the analyte binding moiety is associated with a quencher. "Quencher" refers to a compound that reduces the emission of a fluorophore when in its presence. Quencher (Q) is selected from a discrete compound, a reactive intermediate which is convertible to a second discrete compound or to a polymerizable compound or Q is a pendant group or chain unit in a polymer prepared from said reactive intermediate or polymerizable compound, which polymer is water-soluble or dispersible or is an insoluble polymer, said polymer is optionally crosslinked.
[0129] In one example, the binding moiety that provides glucose recognition in the embodiments is an aromatic boronic acid. In some embodiments, the binding moiety may be a quencher comprising a boronic acid functionalized to either a pyridinium cation (or salt) as disclosed in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2008/0305009 or a polyviologen as disclosed in US. Patent Application Publication No. 2009/0081803; each of which is hereby incorporated herein in its entirety by reference thereto. In some embodiments, the boronic acid is covalently bonded to a conjugated nitrogen-containing heterocyclic aromatic bis-onium structure (e.g., a viologen). "Viologen" refers generally to compounds having the basic structure of a nitrogen containing conjugated N-substituted heterocyclic aromatic bis-onium salt, such as 2,2'-, 3,3'- or 4,4'-N,N' bis-(benzyl) bipyridium dihalide (i.e., dichloride, bromide chloride), etc. Viologen also includes the substituted phenanthroline compounds. In some embodiments, the boronic acid substituted quencher preferably has a pKa of between about 4 and 9, and reacts reversibly with glucose in aqueous media at a pH from about 6.8 to 7.8 to form boronate esters. The extent of reaction is related to glucose concentration in the medium. Formation of a boronate ester diminishes quenching of the fluorophore by the viologen resulting in an increase in fluorescence dependent on glucose concentration. A useful bis-onium salt is compatible with the analyte solution and capable of producing a detectable change in the fluorescent emission of the dye in the presence of the analyte to be detected.
[0130] In some embodiments, a binding moiety may comprise an analyte binding protein operably coupled to a fluorophore, such as the glucose binding proteins disclosed in U.S. Patent Nos. 6,197,534, 6,227,627, 6,521,447, 6,855,556, 7,064,103, 7,316,909, 7,326,538, 7,345,160, and 7,496,392, U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2003/0232383, 2005/0059097, 2005/0282225, 2009/0104714, 2008/0311675, 2008/0261255, 2007/0136825, 2007/0207498, and 2009/0048430, and PCT International Publication Nos. WO 2009/021052, WO 2009/036070, WO 2009/021026, WO 2009/021039, WO 2003/060464, and WO 2008/072338 which are hereby incorporated by reference herein in their entireties.
[0131] Bis-onium salts in the embodiments of this invention are prepared from conjugated heterocyclic aromatic di-nitrogen compounds. The conjugated heterocyclic aromatic di-nitrogen compounds are selected from dipyridyls, dipyridyl ethylenes, dipyridyl phenylenes, phenanthrolines, and diazafluorenes, wherein the nitrogen atoms are in a different aromatic ring and are able to form an onium salt. It is understood that all isomers of said conjugated heterocyclic aromatic di-nitrogen compounds in which both nitrogens can be substituted are useful in this invention. In one embodiment, the quencher may be one of the bis-onium salts derived from 3,3 '-dipyridyl, 4,4'-dipyridyl and 4,7-phenanthroline.
[0132] In some embodiments, the viologen-boronic acid adduct may be a discrete compound having a molecular weight of about 400 Daltons or greater. In other embodiments, it may also be a pendant group or a chain unit of a water-soluble or water-dispersible polymer with a molecular weight greater than about 10,000 Daltons. In one embodiment, the quencher- polymer unit may be non-covalently associated with a polymer matrix and is physically immobilized therein. In yet another embodiment, the quencher-polymer unit may be immobilized as a complex with a negatively charge water-soluble polymer.
[0133] In other embodiments, the viologen-boronic acid moiety may be a pendant group or a chain unit in a crosslinked, hydrophilic polymer or hydrogel sufficiently permeable to the analyte (e.g., glucose) to allow equilibrium to be established.
[0134] In other embodiments, the quencher may be covalently bonded to a second water-insoluble polymer matrix M2, which can be represented by the structure M2-L2-Q. L2 is a linker selected from the group consisting of a lower alkylene (e.g., C]-C8 alkylene), sulfonamide, amide, quaternary ammonium, pyridinium, ester, ether, sulfide, sulfone, phenylene, urea, thiourea, urethane, amine, and a combination thereof. The quencher may be linked to M2 at one or two sites in some embodiments.
[0135] For the polymeric quencher precursors, multiple options are available for attaching the boronic acid moiety and a reactive group which may be a polymerizable group or a coupling group to two different nitrogens in the heteroaromatic centrally located group. These are:
a) a reactive group on a first aromatic moiety is attached to one nitrogen and a second aromatic group containing at least one -B(OH)2 group is attached to the second nitrogen; b) one or more boronic acid groups are attached to a first aromatic moiety which is attached to one nitrogen and one boronic acid and a reactive group are attached to a second aromatic group which second aromatic group is attached to the second nitrogen;
c) one boronic acid group and a reactive group are attached to a first aromatic moiety which first aromatic group is attached to one nitrogen, and a boronic acid group and a reactive group are attached to a second aromatic moiety which is attached to the second nitrogen; and
d) one boronic acid is attached to each nitrogen and a reactive group is attached to the heteroaromatic ring.
[0136] Preferred embodiments comprise two boronic acid moieties and one polymerizable group or coupling group wherein the aromatic group is a benzyl substituent bonded to the nitrogen and the boronic acid groups are attached to the benzyl ring and may be in the ortho- meta or para- positions. [0137] In some embodiments, the boronic acid substituted viologen as a discrete compound useful for in vitro sensing may be represented by one of the following formulas:
Figure imgf000040_0001
Figure imgf000040_0002
2X
Y1-(CH2)n-N <x //
2X® n(H2C)-Y2
[0138] where n = 1-3, X is halogen, and Y1 and Y2 are independently selected from phenyl boronic acid (o- m- or p-isomers) and naphthyl boronic acid. In other embodiments, the quencher may comprise a boronic acid group as a substituent on the heterocyclic ring of a viologen.
[0139] A specific example used with TSPP is m-BBV:
Figure imgf000040_0003
m-BBV
[0140] The quencher precursors suitable for making sensors may be selected from the following:
Figure imgf000040_0004
Figure imgf000041_0001
3,3'-oBBV
[0141] The quencher precursor 3,3'-oBBV may be used with HPTS-LysMA or HPTS-CysMA to make hydrogels in accordance with preferred aspects of the invention.
[0142] Preferred quenchers are prepared from precursors comprising viologens derived from 3,3'-dipyridyl substituted on the nitrogens with benzylboronic acid groups and at other positions on the dipyridyl rings with a polymerizable group or a coupling group. Representative viologens include:
Figure imgf000042_0002
[0143] where L is LI or L2 and is a linking group
[0144] Z is a reactive group; and
[0145] R' is— B(OH)2 in the ortho- meta- or para- positions on the benzyl ring and R" is H- ; or optionally R" is a coupling group as is defined herein or a substituent specifically used to modify the acidity of the boronic acid such as fluoro- or methoxy-
[0146] L is a divalent moiety that covalently connects the sensing moiety to a reactive group that is used to bind the viologen to a polymer or matrix. Examples of L include those which are each independently selected from a direct bond or, a lower alkylene having 1 to 8 carbon atoms, optionally terminated with or interrupted by one or more divalent connecting groups selected from sulfonamide (-S02NH-), amide -(C=0)N-, ester -(C=0)-0-, ether -0-, sulfide -S-, sulfone (-S02-), phenylene -C6H4-, urethane -NH(C=0)-0-, urea -NH(C=0)NH-, thiourea -NH(C=S)-NH-, amide -(C=0)NH-, amine -NR- (where R is defined as alkyl having 1 to 6 carbon atoms) and the like.
[0147] Z is either a polymerizable ethylenically unsaturated group selected from but not limited to methacrylamido-, acrylamido-, methacryloyl-, acryloyl-, or styryl- or optionally Z is a reactive functional group, capable of forming a covalent bond with a polymer or matrix. Such groups include but are not limited to -Br, -OH, -SH, -C02H, and -NH2.
[0148] Boronic acid substituted polyviologens are another class of preferred quenchers. The term poly viologen includes: a discrete compound comprised of two or more viologens covalently bonded together by a linking group, a polymer comprised of viologen repeat units in the chain, a polymer with viologen groups pendant to the chain, a dendrimer comprised of viologen units, preferably including viologen terminal groups, an oligomer comprised of viologen units, preferably including viologen endgroups, and combinations thereof. Polymers in which mono-viologen groups form a minor component are not included. The preferred quenchers are water soluble or dispersible polymers, or crosslinked, hydrophilic polymers or hydrogels sufficiently permeable to glucose to function as part of a sensor. Alternatively the polyviologen boronic acid may be directly bonded to an inert substrate.
[0149] A polyviologen quencher as a polymer comprised of viologen repeat units has the formula:
Figure imgf000043_0001
[0150] In another embodiment, the polyviologen boronic acid adducts are formed by covalently linking two or more viologen/boronic acid intermediates. The bridging group is typically a small divalent radical bonded to one nitrogen in each viologen, or to a carbon in the aromatic ring of each viologen, or one bond may be to a ring carbon in one viologen and to a nitrogen in the other. Two or more boronic acid groups are attached to the polyviologen. Optionally, the polyviologen boronic acid adduct is substituted with a polymerizable group or coupling group attached directly to the viologen or to the bridging group. Preferably the polyviologen moiety includes only one such group. Preferably, the bridging group is selected to enhance cooperative binding of the boronic acids to glucose.
[0151] The coupling moiety is a linking group as defined previously with the proviso that the linking group is optionally further substituted with a boronic acid, a polymerizable group, an additional coupling group, or is a segment in a polymer chain in which the viologen is a chain unit, a pendant group, or any combination thereof.
Immobilizing Medium
[0152] The indicator system comprising some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein may include an immobilizing medium whose presence may prevent some of the fiuorophores and/or some of the binding moieties from freely diffusing through the sample. For instance, in certain such embodiments, the immobilizing medium may limit the mobility of the sensing moieties (including one or more types of fluorophores and one or more types of binding moieties) such that they remain physically close enough to one another to react (quenching). Where in vivo sensing is desired, the immobilizing medium is preferably insoluble in an aqueous environment (e.g., intravascular), permeable to the target analytes, and impermeable to the sensing moieties. Where in vitro analyte measurement is desired, the immobilizing medium is preferably insoluble in the sample's solvent, permeable to the target analytes, and, again, impermeable to the sensing moieties. For example, a bench top glucose meter for measuring glucose activity in aqueous solution may comprise a water-insoluble organic polymer matrix that is permeable to the target analytes and impermeable to the sensing moieties. More specifically, the HPTS-triLysMA dye and 3,3'-oBBV quencher may be effectively immobilized within a DMAA (Ν,Ν-dimethylacrylamide) hydrogel matrix (described in detail below). Such an embodiment may be useful for devices configured for in vitro or in vivo sensing.
[0153] In some embodiments for use in vitro, and not involving a moving stream, the sensing moieties (including one or more types of fluorophores and one or more types of binding moieties) may be used as individual (discrete) components. For example, in some embodiments, the concentration of analyte in a liquid sample may be measured by adding and mixing into the sample the one or more types of fluorophores and binding moieties, exciting the one or more types of fluorophores with light of the appropriate wavelengths, and detecting the intensity of the fluorescence emitted by the fluorophores. Analyte concentration may then be calculated from the measured intensity. Afterwards, the sample has been contaminated with the one or more fluorophores and binding moieties and may need to be discarded. Of course, if the sample is taken from a larger solution, the amount of discarded solution may be insignificant.
[0154] In other embodiments for use in vitro, polymeric matrices may be used to trap the sensing moieties so that the sensing moieties do not permanently contaminate the sample, and so that the sensing moieties may be reused to determine analyte concentration in another sample. In certain such embodiments, the sensing moieties may be immobilized allowing their use to measure analytes in a moving stream.
[0155] For in vivo applications, some embodiments of the indicator system may be used in a moving stream of physiological fluid which contains one or more analytes, such as polyhydroxyl organic compounds, whose concentration is to be measured. Other embodiments for in vivo applications may be implanted in tissue such as muscle which contains the aforementioned analytes. Thus, for in vivo applications, it is often preferred that the sensing moieties do not escape from the sensor assembly. In some embodiments, this is accomplished by making the sensing moieties a part of an organic polymer sensing assembly. Soluble fluorophores and binding moieties may be confined by a semi-permeable membrane that allows passage of the analyte but blocks passage of the sensing moieties. This can be realized by using as sensing moieties soluble molecules that are substantially larger than the analyte molecules (molecular weight of at least twice that of the analyte or greater than 1000 preferably greater than 5000); and employing a selective semipermeable membrane such as a dialysis or an ultrafiltration membrane with a specific molecular weight cutoff between the two so that the sensing moieties are quantitatively retained. Note, however, that these embodiments will also find substantial utility in in vitro applications where it is desirable to immobilize or constrain the sensing moieties so that they do not freely mix with the sample in a way that they cannot be easily extracted. As stated above, such configurations reduce contamination of the sample and to some extent allow the fluorophores and binding moieties to be reused for multiple samples and analyte measurements.
[0156] Irrespective of whether analyte concentration is to determined in vivo or in vitro, if glucose is the analyte of interest, it is often advantageous that the sensing moieties be immobilized. In some embodiments, the glucose sensing moieties may be immobilized in an insoluble polymer matrix, which is freely permeable to glucose. The polymer matrix may include of organic, inorganic or combinations of polymers thereof. For in vivo measurements, it may be advantageous for the matrix to be composed of biocompatible materials. Alternatively or additionally, the matrix may be coated with a second biocompatible polymer that is permeable to the analytes of interest. For in vitro measurements, the use of biocompatible materials may not be necessary or even advantageous.
[0157] In some embodiments where the indicator system includes a polymer matrix, the function of the polymer matrix is to hold together and immobilize the one or more fluorophores and one or more binding moieties while at the same time allowing contact and binding between the analyte and the one or more binding moieties. To achieve this effect, the matrix must be insoluble in the solution containing the analyte, but also be in close association with it through the establishment of a high surface area interface between matrix and analyte solution. For example, in some embodiments, an ultra-thin film or microporous support matrix may be used. In some embodiments, the matrix may be swellable in the analyte solution. For some embodiments used to measure analyte concentrations is aqueous solutions, a hydrogel matrix may be used. In some instances, the sensing polymers are bonded to a surface such as the surface of a light conduit, or impregnated in a microporous membrane. Preferably, the matrix does not substantially interfere with transport of the analyte to the binding sites so that equilibrium may be established between the two phases. Techniques for preparing ultra-thin films, microporous polymers, microporous sol-gels, and hydrogels are established in the art. Useful matrices are typically substantially permeable to the analyte being examined.
[0158] Hydrogel polymers are used in some embodiments. The term, hydrogel, as used herein refers to a polymer that swells substantially, but does not dissolve in water. Such hydrogels may be linear, branched, or network polymers, or polyelectrolyte complexes, with the proviso that they contain no soluble or leachable fractions. Typically, hydrogel networks are prepared by a crosslinking step, which is performed on water-soluble polymers so that they swell but do not dissolve in aqueous media. Alternatively, the hydrogel polymers are prepared by copolymerizing a mixture of hydrophilic and crosslinking monomers to obtain a water swellable network polymer. Such polymers are formed either by addition or condensation polymerization, or by combination process. In these embodiments, the one or more fluorophores and one or more binding moieties may be incorporated into the polymer by copolymerization using monomeric derivatives in combination with network-forming monomers. Alternatively, the one or more fluorophores and one or more binding moieties may be coupled to an already prepared matrix using a post polymerization reaction. In either case, the one or more fluorophores and one or more binding moieties can be viewed as units in the polymer chain, or as pendant groups attached to the chain.
[0159] The hydrogels useful in this invention are also monolithic polymers, such as a single network to which both sensing moieties are covalently bonded, or as multi-component hydrogels. Multi-component hydrogels include interpenetrating networks, polyelectrolyte complexes, and various other blends of two or more polymers to obtain a water swellable composite, which includes dispersions of a second polymer in a hydrogel matrix and alternating microlayer assemblies.
[0160] Monolithic hydrogels are typically formed by free radical copolymerization of a mixture of hydrophilic monomers, including but not limited to HEMA, PEGMA, methacrylic acid, hydroxyethyl acrylate, N-vinyl pyrrolidone, acrylamide, Ν,Ν'-dimethyl acrylamide, and the like; ionic monomers include methacryloylaminopropyl trimethylammonium chloride, diallyl dimethyl ammonium, chloride, vinyl benzyl trimethyl ammonium chloride, sodium sulfopropyl methacrylate, and the like; crosslinkers include ethylene dimethacrylate, PEGDMA, trimethylolpropane triacrylate, and the like. The ratios of monomers are chosen to optimize network properties including permeability, swelling index, and gel strength using principles well established in the art. In one embodiment, the fluorophore is derived from an ethylenically unsaturated derivative of a dye molecule, such as 8-acetoxypyrene-l,3,6-N, N', N"- tris(methacrylamidopropylsulfonamide), the binding moiety is derived from an ethylenically unsaturated viologen such as 4-N-(benzyl-3-boronic acid)-4'-N'-(benzyl-4ethenyl)-dipyridinium dihalide (m-SBBV) and the matrix is made from HEMA and PEGDMA. The concentration of fluorophore is chosen to optimize emission intensity. The ratio of binding moiety to fluorophore is adjusted to provide sufficient binding to produce the desired measurable signal.
[0161] In some embodiments, a monolithic hydrogel is formed by a condensation polymerization. For example, acetoxy pyrene trisulfonyl chloride is reacted with an excess of PEG diamine to obtain a tris-(amino PEG) adduct dissolved in the unreacted diamine. A solution of excess trimesoyl chloride and an acid acceptor is reacted with 4-N-(benzyl-3-boronic acid)-4'- N'-(2 hydroxyethyl) bipyridinium dihalide to obtain an acid chloride functional ester of the viologen. The two reactive mixtures are brought into contact with each other and allowed to react to form the hydrogel, e.g. by casting a thin film of one mixture and dipping it into the other.
[0162] In other embodiments, multi-component hydrogels wherein the fluorophore is incorporated in one component and the binding moiety in another are preferred for making the sensor of this invention. Further, these systems are optionally molecularly imprinted to enhance interaction between components and to provide selectivity for glucose over other polyhydroxy analytes. Preferably, the multicomponent system is an interpenetrating polymer network (IPN) or a semi-interpenetrating polymer network (semi-IPN).
[0163] The IPN polymers are typically made by sequential polymerization. First, a network comprising the binding moiety is formed. The network is then swollen with a mixture of monomers including the fluorophore monomer and a second polymerization is carried out to obtain the IPN hydrogel.
[0164] The semi-IPN hydrogel is formed by dissolving a soluble polymer containing a fluorophore in a mixture of monomers including a binding moiety monomer and polymerizing the mixture. In some embodiments, the sensing components are immobilized by an insoluble polymer matrix which is freely permeable to polyhydroxyl compounds. Additional details on hydrogel systems have been disclosed in US Patent Publications Nos. US2004/0028612, and 2006/0083688 which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entireties.
[0165] The polymer matrix is comprised of organic, inorganic or combinations of polymers thereof. The matrix may be composed of biocompatible materials. Alternatively, the matrix is coated with a second biocompatible polymer that is permeable to the analytes of interest. The function of the polymer matrix is to hold together and immobilize the fluorophore and binding moieties while at the same time allowing contact with the analytes (e.g., polyhydroxyl compounds, H+ and OH"), and binding of the polyhydroxyl compounds to the boronic acid. Therefore, the matrix is insoluble in the medium and in close association with it by establishing a high surface area interface between matrix and analyte solution. The matrix also does not interfere with transport of the analyte to the binding sites so that equilibrium can be established between the two phases. In one embodiment, an ultra-thin film or microporous support matrix may be used. In another embodiment, the matrix that is swellable in the analyte solution (e.g. a hydrogel matrix) can be used for aqueous systems. In some embodiments, the sensing polymers are bonded to a surface such as the surface of a light conduit, or impregnated in a microporous membrane. Techniques for preparing ultra-thin films, microporous polymers, microporous sol-gels, and hydrogels have been established in the prior art.
[0166] In one preferred embodiment, the boronic acid substituted viologen may be covalently bonded to a fluorophore. The adduct may be a polymerizable compound or a unit in a polymer. One such adduct for example may be prepared by first forming an unsymmetrical viologen from 4,4'-dipyridyl by attaching a benzyl-3-boronic acid group to one nitrogen and an aminoethyl group to the other nitrogen atom. The viologen is condensed sequentially first with 8-acetoxy-pyrene-l,3,6-trisulfonyl chloride in a 1 :1 mole ratio followed by reaction with excess PEG diamine to obtain a prepolymer mixture. An acid acceptor is included in both steps to scavenge the byproduct acid. The prepolymer mixture is crosslinked by reaction with a polyisocyanate to obtain a hydrogel. The product is treated with base to remove the acetoxy blocking group. Incomplete reaction products and unreacted starting materials are leached out of the hydrogel by exhaustive extraction with deionized water before further use. The product is responsive to glucose when used as the sensing component as described herein.
[0167] Alternatively, such adducts are ethylenically unsaturated monomer derivatives. For example, dimethyl bis-bromomethyl benzene boronate is reacted with excess 4,4'-dipyridyl to form a half viologen adduct. After removing the excess dipyridyl, the adduct is further reacted with an excess of bromoethylamine hydrochloride to form the bis-viologen adduct. This adduct is coupled to a pyranine dye by reaction with the 8-acetoxypyrene-tris sulfonyl chloride in a 1 :1 mole ratio in the presence of an acid acceptor followed by reaction with excess aminopropylmethacrylamide. Finally, any residual amino groups may be reacted with methacrylol chloride. After purification, the dye/viologen monomer may be copolymerized with HEMA and PEGDMA to obtain a hydrogel.
[0168] For example U.S. Pat. No. 5,1 14,676 (incorporated by reference herein in its entirety) provides a fluorescent indicator which may be covalently attached to a particle or to a macrocrystalline cellulose fiber. A sensor utilizing the indicator may comprise an optically transparent substrate, a thermoplastic layer and a hydrogel. Part of the particle with the indicator attached thereto is imbedded in a thermoplastic layer that is coated on the substrate and mechanically adhered using heat and pressure. The majority of the particle/indicator is imbedded within a hydrogel layer that is applied over the thermoplastic layer. Such a sensor may be applied to the tip of an optical waveguide. Furthermore, with the recent availability of low cost UV LEDs, the dye can be measured with relatively inexpensive instrumentation that combines UV and blue LEDs and a photodiode module. In one embodiment of the present invention, the preferred sensing device comprises at least one light source, a detector, and a sensor comprising a fluorescent reporter dye system. In one embodiment, the fluorescent reporter dye system comprises a fluorescent dye operably coupled to an analyte-binding quencher. The dye may be covalently bound to the quencher or merely associated with the quencher. The dye and quencher are preferably operably coupled, which means that in operation, the quencher is in close enough proximity to the dye to interact with and modulate its fluorescence. In one embodiment, the dye and quencher may be constrained together within an analyte-permeable hydrogel or other polymeric matrix. When excited by light of appropriate wavelength, the fluorescent dye emits light (e.g., fluoresces). The intensity of the light is dependent on the extent of quenching which varies with the amount of analyte binding. In other embodiments, the fluorescent dye and the quencher may be covalently attached to hydrogel or other polymeric matrix, instead of to one another.
Protective Housing
[0169] In some embodiments, the sensor probe 200 of the measurement device includes a protective housing 500 which provides protection to the indicator system 307. In embodiments wherein the indicator system 307 comprises an immobilizing medium, the protective housing 500 may further protect the immobilizing medium. In certain such embodiments, the protective housing 500 may be appropriately sized for in vitro bench top laboratory use. In some embodiments, a protective housing 500 may provide a protective benefit to a sensor probe 200 that is designed for in vivo analyte measurement, and in some embodiments, more specifically, for a sensor probe 200 that is designed for intravascular analyte measurement. In certain such embodiments, the protective housing 500 may be constructed of physiologically compatible materials and may be sized for intravascular deployment. In embodiments wherein the sensor probe 200 includes a temperature sensing element, the temperature sensing element may be contained within the protective housing 500.
[0170] In some embodiments, such as the embodiments schematically depicted in Figures 7 A and 7B, the protective housing 500 may be constructed of a hollow tube comprising a first material 501, and a second material 502 coating the first material 501. In some embodiments, the second material 502 may coat the first material 501 so as to form a continuous substantially impermeable outer wall of the hollow tube, except in a region where a portion of the second material 502 has been selectively removed in order to generate at least one opening in the outer wall, while retaining the first material 501 in that region. Three square cutouts 503 in the outer wall of the tube arranged in a line can be seen in Figures 7A and 7B, but cutouts of other shapes, positioned in other arrangements, are clearly feasible, depending on the embodiments. In some embodiments, such as the embodiment schematically illustrated in Figure 7A, the first material 501 may form a tubular mesh 501 A. In some embodiments, such as the embodiment schematically illustrated in Figure 7B, the first material 501 may form a coil 501B. For each of the embodiments schematically illustrated in these figures, the first material 501 (whether in the form of a tubular mesh 501A or a coil 501B) is visible in the figures through the cutouts 503 in outer wall formed by the second material 502.
[0171] Examples of materials suitable for use as the coil or tubular mesh (i.e. the first material 501) include both metallic and non-metallic materials. Suitable metallic materials include stainless steel, gold, titanium and silver, and alloys such as nitinol, beryllium copper and MP-35-N alloys comprising cobalt, nickel, chromium, and molybdenum. In some embodiments, stainless steel is preferred. Suitable non-metallic materials include synthetic polymers such as polyamides, polyesters, polyurethanes, polyolefins, nylon and fiuoropolymers, for example polytetrafluoroethylene (PTFE). The first material 501 must, however, be chosen so that it is possible to selectively remove a region of the second material 502 which coats the first material, without the first material itself being removed in that region.
[0172] As mentioned above, the first material 501 can be in the form of a coil 501B, see Figure 7B, or a tubular mesh 501 A, see Figure 7A. When in the form of a coil 501B, the coil can be made from wires of the first material 501 which preferably have either a round or flat cross-section. When in the form of a tubular mesh 501 A, the mesh structure advantageously comprises a number of filaments. The term "filament" is used to refer to any elongated strand irrespective of its cross-sectional configuration and structure. For example, the filaments may be round or flat in cross-section. In one embodiment, the mesh can comprise a number of helically wound filaments, for example comprising a first group of filaments wound in an anticlockwise direction and a second group of filaments wound in an opposite, clockwise direction. The tubular mesh 501A of Figure 7A displays this configuration. Suitable mesh structures are described in International publication No. WO/2004/054438 which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety.
[0173] In some embodiments wherein the first material 501 is in the form of a tubular mesh 501 A, the density of filament crossovers may be varied in order to control the properties of the resulting hollow tube. For example, a high density mesh may engender the hollow tube with greater strength while a low density mesh provide the hollow tube with greater flexibility. Variation in the tightness of a coil can provide a similar effect.
[0174] Variation in mesh density and/or coil tightness may also vary the porosity of the mesh. This variation may be significant at the location of the opening in the outer wall formed by the second material since the porosity of the mesh in this region will control the speed of diffusion of the analyte into the sensor. Porosity is also important for embodiments employing an immobilizing medium because, in certain such embodiments, the mesh may need to be sufficiently dense (or the coil winding sufficiently tight) to prevent seepage or leakage of the immobilizing medium out of the sensor's protective housing. Thus, in some embodiments, coil tightness and/or mesh density must be chosen simultaneously to give the protective housing sufficient strength and flexibility to protect against impacts and abrasions, to allow sufficient diffusion of analytes into the protective housing, and to contain the immobilizing medium so that it does not leak out of the protective housing. Obviously, in embodiments lacking an immobilizing medium, leakage of an immobilizing medium out of the protective housing need not be considered.
[0175] Suitable materials for use as the second material generally include polymeric materials. Examples include polyesters, polyolefins such as polyethylene (PE), e.g. low density polyethylene (LDPE), fluoropolymers such as fluorinated ethylene propylene (FEP), polytetrafluoroethylene (PTFE) and perfluoroalkoxy polymer (PFA), polyvinylchloride (PVC), polyamides such as polyether block amide (PEBA), Pebax®, nylon and polyurethane. Polyesters and polyolefins are preferred due to their suitability for extrusion over the coil or tubular mesh. The selective removal of a portion of a polyester or polyolefin coating, e.g. by laser ablation, is also straightforward. Polyolefins are particularly preferred due to the ease of laser ablating these materials.
[0176] In order to form a continuous substantially impermeable tube prior to selective removal of a portion of the second material, the second material is first used to coat the coil or tubular mesh formed by the first material. The second material can either coat the outer surfaces of the first material, and in effect form a continuous substantially impermeable tube around the coil or tubular mesh formed by the first material, or the second material can entirely encapsulate the first material, effectively forming a tube of the second material in which is embedded the coil or tubular mesh formed by the first material. In one embodiment the second material can be applied to the first material by dip coating the coil or tubular mesh formed by the first material. In this embodiment, the second material may be a polyamide, which results in a very stiff tube. In another embodiment a tube of the second material can be provided, around which is formed the coil or tubular mesh of the first material. A further layer of the second material is then applied over the first material, resulting in the first material being sandwiched between two layers of the second material.
[0177] As mentioned above, it is necessary that it be possible to selectively remove a region of the second material while retaining the first material in that region. Accordingly, it is a requirement that the second material is different from the first material. In this context, "different from" means that the first and second materials have some difference in physical properties such that it is possible to selectively remove a region of the second material. This difference may be achieved by using an entirely different material, or by using the same material but using different forms which have different physical properties. For example, in one embodiment the first material is metallic and the second material is polymeric.
[0178] In addition to the first and second materials, it is possible to include further materials. For example, for some applications it may be useful to include a radio opaque additive to enable the sensor incorporating the tube to be visible in vivo. For example, radio opaque additives such as barium sulfate, bismuth subcarbonate, bismuth trioxide and tungsten can be added. Where present, these are preferably doped within the second material.
[0179] When constructing the protective housings described above, a portion of the second material is selectively removed in order to generate at least one opening in a region of the outer wall of the protective housing, while retaining the first material in that region. As the first material is present in the form of a coil or a tubular mesh, the first material does not form a completely closed tube. Accordingly, when the second material is removed in said region, this effectively forms a break in the continuous substantially impermeable wall of the tube. Where the second material simply coats the first material, it is necessary simply to remove the coating provided by this second material in the region where the opening is to be formed. Where the second material effectively encapsulates the first material, it is necessary to remove all of the second material which surrounds and encapsulates the first material in the region of the protective housing where the opening is to be formed.
[0180] Preferably the indicator system 307 used to generate a signal indicative of the concentration of the analyte of interest is located adjacent to the opening 503 formed by selective removal of the second material. This allows the indicator system to measure analyte concentration near the region of the opening in the wall of the tube. Presumably, the environment of the fluid in this region is substantially similar to the environment of the fluid further away from the sensor probe's protective housing 500, and therefore the analyte concentration determined in this region will likely accurately represent the analyte concentration elsewhere in the fluid. For example, where the measurement device is an intravascular glucose sensor, the sensor probe 200 and protective housing 500 may be inserted into a blood vessel, for example, and glucose in the blood will preferably migrate through the opening in the second material, and into the hollow tube, where its concentration can be determined by the indicator system in conjunction with the other components of the measurement device. Where the measurement device is a bench top glucose meter, the sensor probe 200 and protective housing 500 may be dipped into a solution contained in a beaker or test tube, for example, such that the opening in the second material is submerged. The solution will then pass through the opening in the second material, into the hollow tube, and the glucose concentration of the solution may be determined by the indicator system in conjunction with the other components of the glucose sensor.
[0181] In some embodiments, the size of the opening in the second material will generally be between 1 and 400 mm2, for example between 25 and 225 mm2. The size of the opening is preferably not too small or the solution into which the sensor is introduced will not be able to pass through the opening or will pass through in insufficient quantities for an accurate measurement to be made. Yet, the opening is preferably not to large or else the immobilizing medium constraining the free diffusion of the sensing moieties may be able to seep out. In some embodiments, it is advantageous that the opening be large enough to allow positioning of the indicator system such that it is adjacent to the opening. [0182] In some embodiments, the second material forming the outer wall of the protective housing 500 possesses only a single opening 503 allowing passing of the analyte. In other embodiments, a plurality of openings 503 may be generated in the outer wall of the protective housing 500— i.e. more than one region of the second material has been removed. For example, the protective housings 500 of the sensor probes 200 displayed in Figures 7A and 7B each possess three regions where the second material 502 has been removed, exposing the first material 501A, 501B, and creating three openings 503 for the passage of analytes. Generally speaking, configurations of multiple openings in the protective housing allow for indicator systems, or portions of indicator systems, to be located at a number of points along the length of the protective housing, and for multiple measurements to be taken. Thus, it is possible for a number of indicator systems to be located within a single protective housing, each measuring the analyte in a portion of the fluid containing the analyte which enters the protective housing through a different opening in the housing. It is also possible that a single indicator system may comprise multiple sub-systems, each of which is spatially separated within the protective housing, and each of which measures the analyte in a portion of the fluid containing the analyte which enters the protective housing through a different opening in the housing.
[0183] Many embodiments of the protective housings 500 disclosed above may, in many instances, provide a robust and durable enclosure for protecting the sensitive components of the sensor probe 200. Such protective housings may protect an in vitro sensor probe from impacts and abrasions occurring during bench top laboratory use. Alternatively, such protective housings may provide the durability and maneuverability necessary for intravascular use. However, it should be understood that many types of protective housings may be suitable for protecting the indicator systems disclosed herein, beyond those particular types of protective housings that have been disclosed above.
Methods of Estimating Analyte Concentration Incorporating Temperature Correction
[0184] Some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein generate a signal indicative of analyte concentration which exhibits a temperature dependence. For example, if two solutions of precisely the same analyte concentration are measured at two different temperatures with the same measurement device, in some embodiments, the measurement device may generate differing signals indicative of the two analyte concentrations. Thus, the accuracy of determining a solution's true analyte concentration based on such as signal may be improved by taking the temperature of the solution into account.
[0185] It has been discovered that for some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein, and in particular, for glucose measurement devices employing a quencher binding moiety operably coupled to a fluorophore, the temperature dependence of the fluorescent signal approximately follows a modified version of the classic Michaelis-Menten equation from enzyme kinetics:
cT * [ j - aT ]
[Glu] (Equation 1) aT + bT— Gj where
[Glu] is the estimated glucose concentration, aT is the first Michaelis-Menten parameter "a", at a temperature T, bT is the second Michaelis-Menten parameter "b", at the same temperature T, cT is the third Michaelis-Menten parameter "c", at the same temperature T, and
Gj is the fluorescent signal (z = 1,2) , either referenced or unreferenced, where G1 is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 470nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore' s base-form), and G2 is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 420nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore' s acid-form). Note, however, that other combinations of excitation and emission wavelengths are also feasible for use in Equation 1. In the Examples below, G2 has been used, unless indicated otherwise.
[0186] In itself, this is an interesting and surprising result. Various embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein employ a quencher-fluorophore indicator system which measures analyte concentration through the establishment of an equilibrium between the analyte of interest, the binding moiety (e.g. quencher), and the fluorophore. In such a system, analyte concentration is not measured by enzymatic consumption or conversion of the analyte. In contrast, the classic Michaelis-Menten equation specifically describes enzyme kinetics, a non- equilibrium phenomena involving the consumption/conversion of the enzyme's substrate by the enzyme. Therefore, it is not to be expected, indeed it is surprising, that an equation closely related to the classic Michaelis-Menten equation would effectively describe the temperature dependence of these types of quencher-fluorophore-based measurement devices and analyte sensing elements (or other measurement devices and analyte sensing elements functioning through analogous equilibrium mechanisms). In any event, knowledge that these devices (and similar devices) exhibit a temperature dependence which follows a modified Michaelis-Menten equation allows the use of temperature correction methods and algorithms to improve the accuracy of analyte concentration measurements. Such methods and algorithms are disclosed herein, along with measurement devices which implement such methods and algorithms.
[0187] Accordingly, some embodiment methods of estimating an analyte concentration include generating a signal indicative of analyte concentration and a signal indicative of temperature. Since, in some embodiments, the signal indicative of analyte concentration exhibits the temperature dependence just described, in some embodiments, the signal indicative of temperature may be used to adjust the signal indicative of analyte concentration to correct for temperature dependence. Thus, in certain such embodiments, the methods further include transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation, such as Equation 1 above, depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, such as the parameters "a", "b", and "c", as described above with reference to Equation 1.
[0188] The temperature dependence of Equation 1 is exhibited through the Michaelis- Menten parameters ατ, br, and cr, as indicated by the subscript "I" labeling these parameters. In some embodiments, the temperature dependence may need to be determined through a temperature calibration. Thus, in certain embodiment methods, the values of one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based on data which includes temperature calibration data and the signal indicative of a temperature.
[0189] For example, in some embodiment methods, the temperature calibration data may be generated by a temperature calibration method. The temperature calibration method may include selecting a first test analyte sensing element, and creating and/or providing a set of at least three solutions of differing known analyte concentrations. In certain such embodiments, a first temperature is selected (77), three solutions of the set of at least three solutions are heated and/or cooled to a temperature substantially similar to the selected first temperature, and a first set of at least three signals is generated using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different one of the three solutions at the first temperature. Measurements are then made at a second temperature. Thus, in certain embodiments, a second temperature is selected (72), three solutions of the set of at least three solutions (each of the three may be the same or different than a solution chosen for the first temperature) are heated and/or cooled to a temperature substantially similar to the selected second temperature, and a second set of at least three signals is generated using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different one of the three solutions at the second temperature. Of course, more than three solutions may be used in either of these steps. And more than two temperatures may also be employed. Generally, the more solutions of differing concentration and the greater number of different temperatures that are employed, the greater the accuracy of the resulting calibration data.
[0190] Once the solutions having known analyte concentrations have been measured, and the first and second sets of at least three signals have been generated, in some embodiments, the sets of signals are used to determine (usually approximately) the relationship between one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters and temperature. For example, in some embodiments, the temperature calibration method may further include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (aTi, bn, and cTi) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a first fit dataset comprising the first set of at least three signals. In certain such embodiments, the temperature calibration method may further include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature (<¾, bn, and cn) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a second fit dataset comprising the second set of at least three signals. Thus, in methods such as these, each of the three Michaelis- Menten parameters has been determined at least two temperatures, providing data which may be used to create a model of the temperature dependence of each of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters.
[0191] To model the temperature dependence of the Michaelis-Menten parameters, in some embodiments, the temperature calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the first Michaelis-Menten parameter (aT) to temperature, the equation depending on a first set of temperature calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the first set of calibration parameters based on the value of the first Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature ( n) and the value of the first Michaelis- Menten parameter at the second temperature (aji)- In some embodiments, similar steps are performed with respect to the second and third Michaelis-Menten parameters (bT and ci). Thus, for example, the temperature calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the second Michaelis-Menten parameter (bT) to temperature, the equation depending on a second set of temperature calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the second set of calibration parameters based on the value of the second Michaelis- Menten parameter at the first temperature (bri) and the value of the second Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature (fe)- Similarly, in some embodiments, the temperature calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the third Michaelis-Menten parameter (c ) to temperature, the equation depending on a third set of temperature calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the third set of calibration parameters based on the value of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (en) and the value of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature (<¾).
[0192] Furthermore, in some embodiments, equations linear in temperature may be selected to relate the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters to temperature. For instance, in some embodiments, the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters may be written as
αΤ = α3Ί * τατ (Τ) >
bT = Z>37 * (Τ) , and (Equation 2)
CT = C37 * TcT {T)
where r (r), T^ (T), and TCT (T) are "temperature correction factors" which approximately account for the temperature dependence of ctj, bj, and cj. When the relationship between Michaelis-Menten parameter and temperature is written as such, each Michaelis-Menten parameter aT, br, and CT, is determined by multiplying the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameterI37, sT, and C37, by its corresponding "temperature correction factor," τ (τ), ^ (r), or τ (τ), respectively. The 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters may be determined by fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a set of signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a plurality of solutions of differing analyte concentrations held at a temperature of 37 °C, as described above with respect to, for example, 77 and 12. Alternatively, the parameters a37, b^, and C37 may be supplied by a factory calibration as described in provisional U.S. patent application No. 61/184,747, "Algorithms for Calibrating an Analyte Sensor," filed June 5, 2009, which is hereby incorporated herein by reference in its entirety. As yet another alternative, 037, b37, and C37 may be determine via a one-point in vivo calibration as also disclosed in the same application.
[0193] To determine the "temperature correction factors," τατ (τ) , τ^ (τ), and
T (r), some embodiment methods may employ a linear approximation. For instance, the temperature correction factors may be written as
x (T) = m„ * T + βη ,
TbT (T) =™bT * T + bT > and (Equation 3) rCr (r)= ¾ * r + ?Cr ,
where the slopes, maT , , mCT , and intercepts, β , β^ , β , are collectively referred to as
"temperature calibration coefficients" ("TempCos").
[0194] In some embodiments, a temperature calibration method used to determine values of these TempCos may require that values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters be determined at a second temperature (T2), different than 37 °C. Values of the parameters at the second temperature {an, br2, and cj ) may be determined by fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a set of signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a plurality of solutions of differing analyte concentrations held at the second temperature, as described above with respect to, for example, Tl and T2. Once this is done, the temperature calibration coefficients ma and ba may be determined by normalizing to 037 both ατ2 and 037, yielding «72/ 037 and 1, and fitting a line to the normalized values versus the two temperatures, T2 and 37 °C. The fit may be determined using linear least squares or any other method of fitting a line to a set of points. The temperature calibration coefficient maT is set equal to the slope of the resulting line and the temperature calibration coefficient β is set equal to the intercept. The other temperature calibration coefficients, m and β, , may be determined similarly from values of br2 and bn, and mCT and β may be determined from values of ¾ and <¾7. Once the calibration is complete, a temperature corrected estimated glucose concentration ([Gl ]) may be computed from a fluorescent signal ( , ) measured at temperature (7), by using the TempCos ( mar , βατ , m^ , β^ , mCT , and β ), the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters 37 °C (a37, bn, and C37), and the temperature (7) in Equations 2 and 3 to compute α , br, and cj, and then plugging ατ, br, cj and the measured fluorescent signal ( G, ) into Equation 1.
[0195] Thus, in some embodiments the first, second, and third sets of temperature calibration parameters may include a slope and an intercept relating temperature to the value of either the first, second, or third Michaelis-Menten parameter. However, equations of other forms may be selected to relate the first, second, or third Michaelis-Menten equation to temperature. In some embodiments, a quadratic or higher-order polynomial in temperature may be suitable and/or desirable.
[0196] When measurement devices are mass produced, it may not be feasible or practical to individually calibrate each measurement device— i.e. use each individual measurement device to generate individual calibration data. It may be more cost effective to select one or more test devices from a batch of mass produced devices, generate calibration data using the one or more test devices, and provide that calibration data to each individual devices produced in the batch. In some embodiments, variability between measurement devices from the same production batch may be, to a large extent, attributable to a particular part of the measurement device. In particular, variability between devices may be attributable to the part of the measurement device which generates a signal indicative of analyte concentration— e.g. the analyte sensing element— and/or the part of the measurement device that generates a signal indicative of temperature— e.g. the temperature sensing element. In these circumstances, as well as others, it may be advantageous to use a calibration method employing multiple test measurement devices, and/or multiple test sensing elements, because calibration over multiple test devices and/or sensing elements may yield more accurate calibration data than calibration methods which only utilize a single test device and/or sensing element. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the calibration method may further include selecting a second test analyte sensing element; generating a third set of at least three signals using the second test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of known analyte concentration at the first temperature (77); and generating a fourth set of at least three signals using the second test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of known analyte concentration at the second temperature (72). Obviously, calibration methods may similarly employ more than two test devices, or more particularly, for instance, more than two test analyte sensing elements.
[0197] In a manner similar to methods utilizing a single test analyte sensing element, after the solutions having known analyte concentrations have been measured and the first, second, third, and fourth sets of at least three signals have been generated, in some embodiments, the sets of signals are used to determine (usually approximately) the relationship between one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters and temperature. For example, in some embodiments, the temperature calibration method may further include (1) computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (an, bn, and en) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a first fit dataset comprising both the first set of at least three signals (which was generated with the first test analyte sensing element at Tl) and the third set of at least three signals (which was generated with the second test analyte sensing element at 77); and (2) computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature an, b , and cn) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a second fit dataset comprising both the second set of at least three signals (which was generated with the first test analyte sensing element at 72) and fourth set of at least three signals (which was generated with the second test analyte sensing element at 72). Essentially, in these types of methods, the signals generated with the second test analyte sensing element are used in a combined fit with the signals generated with the first test analyte sensing element, which results in values for each of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters which take both test analyte sensing elements into account. Alternatively, in some embodiments, a temperature calibration method may take both test analyte sensing elements into account by fitting the signals generated from each test analyte sensing element separately, and then averaging the results to obtain better estimates of the Michaelis-Menten parameters. Thus, in some embodiments, the step of computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (aTi, bTi, and en) by an algorithm may further include fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a third fit dataset comprising the third set of at least three signals, and averaging the results of fitting the third fit dataset with the results of fitting the first fit dataset. In addition, the step of computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature (<¾, bT2, and cTi) by an algorithm may further include fitting a modified Michaelis- Menten equation to a fourth fit dataset comprising the fourth set of at least three signals, and averaging the results of fitting the fourth fit dataset with the results of fitting the second fit dataset.
[0198] Other methods for estimating analyte concentration which incorporate temperature correction features and temperature calibration steps are also disclosed herein. In some embodiments, these methods are similar to those already described above and incorporate similar features, however, additional features may also be disclosed and, in some embodiments, the disclosed methods may be more general and described in more general terms. Since there are many ways to feasibly implement the discoveries disclosed herein for use in estimating analyte concentration, the following additional methods are described in order to illustrate the breadth of implementations that are possible.
[0199] In some embodiments, for instance, a method of estimating an analyte concentration from a signal indicative of the analyte concentration may include transforming the signal using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein the values of one or more Michaelis-Menten parameters have been adjusted for temperature.
[0200] In some embodiments, for instance, a method of estimating an analyte concentration may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration and generating a signal indicative of a temperature, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more temperature calibration parameters and the signal indicative of temperature. One could refer to such an equation as a "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation since the Michaelis-Menten parameters have been explicitly substituted with equations depending on one or more other variables— temperature and the temperature calibration parameters. However, although such a "substituted" equation exhibits a more complicated analytic form, it nevertheless will still express the basic functional relationships of the modified Michaelis-Menten equation. [0201] In some embodiments, the step of transforming the signal indicative of analyte concentration may utilize a "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation in which each of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters have been substituted with first, second, and third calibration equations (respectively), each of the equations depending on sets of first, second, and third temperature calibration parameters (respectively), and each also depending on the signal indicative of temperature. In certain embodiments, at least one of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a polynomial in the signal indicative of temperature. In certain such embodiments, each of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a polynomial in the signal indicative of temperature. In certain embodiments, at least one of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a linear equation in the signal indicative of temperature. In certain such embodiments, each of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a linear equation in the signal indicative of temperature. Thus, for example, if each Michaelis-Menten parameter of Equation 1 above is assumed to exhibit a linear relationship with temperature, then the "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation might appear as
[Glu]
Figure imgf000064_0001
(Equation 4) and, similarly, if each Michaelis-Menten parameter is assumed to exhibit a quadratic relationship with tem erature then the "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation might appear as (Equation 5)
Figure imgf000064_0002
where:
[Glu] is the estimated glucose concentration,
XaT 2 ' XaT l ' αη^ XaT o Άΐβ polynomial coefficients parameterizing aT 's dependence on the temperature T,
XbT XbT i > an<^ Xbr o are polynomial coefficients parameterizing bT 's dependence on the temperature T,
XcT ,2 > XcT \ > an(l XcT o are polynomial coefficients parameterizing c7, 's dependence on the temperature T, and G, is the fluorescent signal ( = 1,2) , either referenced or unreferenced, where G, is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 470nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's base-form), and G2 is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 420nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's acid-form). Note, however, that other combinations of excitation and emission wavelengths are also feasible for use in Equations 4 and 5.
[0202] As stated above, although, the "substituted" equations (Equations 4 and 5) exhibit a more complicated analytic form, they nevertheless still exhibit the basic functional relationships of the modified Michaelis-Menten equation (Equation 1). In other embodiments, the calibration equations substituted into the modified Michaelis-Menten equation may have a functional form other than a polynomial in temperature.
[0203] Thus, as described above, the calibration equations substituted into the modified Michaelis-Menten equation for the Michaelis-Menten parameters may take a variety of functional forms and each may have varying numbers of temperature calibration parameters. Obviously, more complicated equations may have a greater numbers of temperature calibration parameters. In any event, depending on the embodiment, various temperature calibration methods may be used to determine the values of the first, second, and third sets of the one or more temperature calibration parameters. In certain such embodiments, each set of temperature calibration parameters may be determined by fitting the "substituted" modified Michaelis- Menten equation to a plurality of signals, the plurality of signals indicative of analyte concentration in a plurality of solutions at a plurality of temperatures. Once values of the various temperature calibration parameters are determined, temperature corrected estimates of analyte concentrations may be generated from signals indicative of analyte concentration and temperature.
Example 1
[0204] This example concerns the temperature calibration of an equilibrium fluorescence glucose sensor— referred to herein as a GluCath sensor— employing an HPTS-Cys- MA dye operably coupled to a 3,3'-oBBV quencher. The dye and quencher are immobilized within a hydrogel disposed along the distal region of an optical fiber, while the proximal end of the optical fiber is coupled to a light source. The temperature dependence of this sensor's fluorescence response to glucose was assumed to be described by the modified Michaelis- Menten equation of Equation 1 as described above. The Michaelis-Menten parameters were assumed to bear a linear relationship to temperature as set forth in Equations 2 and 3 above. Using this model of the glucose sensor's temperature dependence, the TempCos mar , β , m^ ,
Ar > mcT > and βοτ ) were determined by the methodology described above in reference to
Equations 2 and 3. Specifically, the effect of temperature on the fluorescent signal was determined experimentally by measuring the signal at four temperatures (15 °C, 25 °C, 37 °C, and 45 °C) and four glucose concentrations (50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL). At each temperature and glucose level the stable signal, G2 , was recorded.
[0205] This data is displayed in Figures 8-10. Figure 8 displays four plots of fluorescent signal versus glucose concentration— one plot for each of these four temperatures. Figure 9 displays the same data with each constant temperature plot normalized to the value of its fluorescent signal at 50 mg/dL. Figure 10 displays essentially the same raw data as Figure 8, but instead displays four plots of fluorescent signal versus temperature— one plot for each of the four glucose concentrations. Apparent from Figure 10, is that the fluorescent signal's temperature dependence— at constant glucose concentration— is approximately linear.
[0206] Using the data plotted in Figure 8, values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters at 15 °C, a15, bjs, and c]5, were determined by fitting (using linear least squares) the modified Michaelis-Menten equation of Equation 1 to the fluorescence data generated at 15 °C. Similarly, values of <¾5, b2s, and c25 were determined by fitting Equation 1 to the fluorescence data generated at 25 °C; values of a37, bn, and c37 were determined by fitting Equation 1 to the fluorescence data generated at 57 °C; and finally, values of a4s, b4$, and c45 were determined by fitting Equation 1 to the fluorescence data generated at 45 °C.
[0207] The process was repeated over four additional glucose sensors of the same design as the first to improve the accuracy of the calibration. Thus, fluorescent signals were generated with each of the four additional glucose sensors, at each of the same four temperatures (15 °C, 25 °C, 37 °C, and 45 °C), and at each of the same four glucose concentrations (50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL). This data corresponding to each of the four sensors was fit with Equation 1 (as was done with the initial sensor) in order to generate values of a 15, a25, CI37, a45, bjs, b25, b37, b4s, c15, c25, c37, and c45 for each additional glucose sensor. The data was averaged over all five sensors for each of these quantities to generate al5 , a25 , a31 , 45 , bl5 , b.
37 ' ^45 ' ^15 ' ^ 25 ' ^37 ' and c 45 ·
[0208] Determination of the temperature calibration parameters (TempCos) corresponding to Equations 2 and 3 was done using these averaged values. Thus, the temperature calibration parameters corresponding to the "a" Michaelis-Menten parameter— i.e. maj and β — were determined by normalizing each of the "a" parameters to a31 and fitting a line (again using linear least squares) to a plot of these values— i.e. a15/a31 , a25/a31 , 1 , a45/a37 versus temperature— the slope and intercept being mar and βατ , respectively. The same was done with the temperature calibration parameters and , corresponding to the
"b" Michaelis-Menten parameter, and mCr and , corresponding to the "c" Michaelis-Menten parameter. The resulting values for these TempCos are summarized in the Table 1, below.
Figure imgf000067_0001
[0209] An equation for computing a temperature corrected glucose concentration from a fluorescent signal and these temperature calibration parameters may be derived by substituting Equation 2 into Equation 1 which yields
(Equation 6)
Figure imgf000067_0002
and then, using Equation 3, further substituting for τα(τ), rb (T), and Tc(T) in Equation which yields
c31 * {mc * T + be)* [G, -a31 * {ma * T + ba)]
[Glu] = (Equation 7) a31 * (ma *T + ba)+b37 * (mb *T + bb)-G,
Example 2 [0210] This example also concerns the temperature calibration of an equilibrium fluorescence glucose GluCath sensor. Again, the GluCath sensor employs an HPTS-Cys-MA dye operably coupled to a 3,3'-oBBV quencher, with the dye and quencher immobilized within a hydrogel disposed along the distal region of an optical fiber, while the proximal end of the optical fiber is coupled to a light source. The temperature dependence of this sensor's fluorescence response to glucose was assumed to be described by the modified Michaelis- Menten equation of Equation 1 as described above. The Michaelis-Menten parameters were assumed to bear a linear relationship to temperature as set forth in Equations 2 and 3 above. Using this model of the glucose sensor's temperature dependence, the TempCos, m , βατ , , β^ , mCr , and β , were determined by the methodology described above in reference to
Equations 2 and 3. Specifically, the effect of temperature on the fluorescent signal was determined experimentally by measuring the signal at four temperatures (15 °C, 25 °C, 37 °C, and 45 °C) and four glucose concentrations (50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL). At each temperature and glucose level the stable signal, G2 , was recorded. The raw data from this experiment is plotted in Figure 11.
[0211] Figure 12 plots glucose response— G2 versus glucose concentration— for each of the four temperatures. This figure illustrates that the fluorescent signal G2 is inversely related to temperature and also that there are large differences in the fluorescent signal G2 at all glucose levels over the range of temperatures likely to be encountered in the intensive care unit— i.e. 15 °C to 45 °C. At each fixed temperature, the modified Michaelis-Menten equation (equation 1) was fit to the fluorescent signal G2 versus glucose concentration to determine best-fit values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters ατ, br, and CT at each temperature. The four best-fit modified Michaelis-Menten equations are overlaid on the data in Figure 12. The quality of the fits is evident from the figure.
[0212] Figure 13 plots each of aT, bT, and cT versus temperature, the values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters corresponding to the best-fits displayed in Figure 12. The plots of each of aT, br, and CT versus temperature illustrate that, in some embodiments, best-fit values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters change approximately linearly with temperature. The best-fit values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters at each temperature were normalized to their values at 37 °C and the normalized values were fit using linear regression to compute slopes and intercepts as shown in Figure 14.
[0213] The slopes and intercepts displayed in Figure 14 correspond to the "temperature calibration coefficients" mar , , , β , β^ , and β , i.e. "TempCos," as described above. The particular values computed from the data in this example are listed in Table 2, below.
Figure imgf000069_0001
[0214] The TempCos can then be used to predict the temperature dependent Michaelis-Menten parameters ατ, br, and c by multiplying the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters a37, bs7, and C37, by a temperature correction factor, τ (τ), τ^ (τ), or τ (T), respectively, as indicated by Equation 3. Again, the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters a37, b37, and C37 may be measured at calibration, determined by a factory calibration, or potentially supplied by any other appropriate method.
[0215] In order to illustrate the accuracy of employing the above-described temperature correction methodology, these TempCos were used to perform temperature correction on an independent data set, as illustrated in Figure 15. In the independent data set, the G2 fluorescent signal versus plasma glucose concentration was measured at four reference plasma glucose levels (50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL) and at four temperatures (15 °C, 25 °C, 37 °C, and 45 °C). The reference measurements of plasma glucose level are indicated as single points (small and medium sized circles) in Figure 15. Temperature measurements as determined by thermocouple are also displayed.
[0216] The other curve displayed in Figure 15 is the temperature corrected plasma glucose concentration. To compute this curve, the four reference plasma glucose levels at 37 °C (indicated by medium sized circles in Figure 15) were fit to a modified Michaelis-Menten equation (Equation 1, as previously described) to generate values of the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters (<¾7, bn, and C37). The temperature corrected plasma glucose concentration curve in Figure 15 was then computed at each temperature read by the thermocouple by inputting into Equations 2 and 3 these 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters (a37, bn, and c37), the TempCos ( mOT , m^ , mCr , β , β^ , and β , as determined in the table above), and the corresponding temperature read by the thermocouple. The temperature corrected plasma glucose concentration curve matches closely the reference plasma glucose levels (indicated by the small and medium sized circles) in Figure 15. In fact, the mean absolute relative deviation ("MARD") between the computed temperature corrected plasma glucose concentrations and the reference plasma glucose levels was only 2.46% (excluding the 37 °C reference values used for calibration). The MARD for the same data set without temperature correction was 170%.
Methods of Measuring pH
[0217] If a solution's measured analyte concentration is to be corrected for pH effects, the pH of the solution must be measured or estimated in some manner. In some embodiments a separate pH sensor may be used to measure pH. In other embodiments, the same indicator system which is used to generate a signal indicative of analyte concentration may be used to measure pH. For instance, the ratio of two green signals generated by the indicator system may be used to compu through the following relationship:
(Equation 8)
Figure imgf000070_0001
where mpH is the slope and βρΗ is the intercept of pH versus G G2 . The ratio, G G2 , is calculated from G, which is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 470nm, and G2 which is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 420nm. The approximate linearity of the relationship between G G2 and pH is illustrated in Figure 16 over a range of glucose concentrations {50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL) and pH levels (6.8, 7.2, 7.4, and 7.8), although some greater deviation from linearity occurs between pH 7.4 and pH 7.8. Note, that G G2 is represented in Figure 16 as Ibase/Iacid since, as indicated above, 470nm is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's base-form, and 420nm is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's acid-form. Also, note that the values of G,/G2 plotted in Figure 16 have been normalized to the 100 mg/dL , pH 7.4 value of G G2 . Thus, Equation 8 may be used to predict pH level from the G G2 ratio once the constants mpH and β H have been determined. In some embodiments, each analyte measurement device may be individually calibrated to determine the constants m H and β H appropriate for that individual device. In other embodiments, an entire batch of measurement devices may be calibrated by selecting several devices from the batch, determining values of mpH and βρΗ for each selected device, and averaging the values of m H and β H obtained for each selected devices to produce averaged values of m H and β H valid for the entire batch of measurement devices for use with Equation 8. In still other embodiments, averaged values of m H and βρΗ may be determined as just described, but a one-point calibration is performed to individually calibrate each sensor in the batch while taking advantage of the averaged values of m H and βρΗ obtained for the entire batch. For instance, in some embodiments, the one point calibration performed on each individual measuring device may involve using the individual device to measure G, and G2 for a standard solution having a glucose concentration of 100 mg/dL at pH 7.4. These values may then be used in Equation 9
(Equation 9)
Figure imgf000071_0001
where:
G, is the fluorescent emission, either referenced or unreferenced, at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 470nm, which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's base-form (although other combinations of excitation and emission wavelengths are also feasible for use as the numerator of the Gj/G2 ratio in Equation 9),
G2 is the fluorescence emission, either referenced or unreferenced, at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 420nm, which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's acid-form (although other combinations of excitation and emission wavelengths are also feasible for use as the denominator of the Gj/G2 ratio in Equation 9), j 74 = G, signal at H 7.4 and 100 mg/dL glucose concentration, G2 74 = G2 signal at pH 7.4 and 100 mg/dL glucose concentration, mpH = pH slope, and βρΗ = pH intercept.
[0218] Thus, once universal values of m H and β H are determined for the batch of measurement devices , and G1 74 and G2 74 are determined via one-point calibration for the individual measurement device, a measured ratio Gl/G2 may be used in Equation 9 to compute the pH level of the solution of analyte. It was also discovered that the determination of pH from Gj/G2 is effected by the temperature of the solution— see for instance, Example 3, below. Moreover, for purposes of estimating pH from the measured ratio G G2 , the temperature dependence may be taken into account by allowing mpH and β H to vary with temperature. In particular, the temperature dependence of mpH and β H may be modeled using Equations 10 and 11 :
m pHH = - j, + i (Equation 10) fipH = j * sfr + k (Equation 11 ) where h, i,j, and k are empirically determined constants— see, for instance, Example 3, below. Substituting Equations 10 and 11 into Equation 9 gives an expression for computing pH from the ratio G, /G2 which accurately, albeit approximately, takes temperature into account.
I T (G / \ + j (Equation 12)
1,7.4
/ ^2,7.4
Example 3
[0219] In order to accurately determine pH from the measured G, /G2 ratio using Equation 12, so as to take temperature into account, testing was conducted to empirically determine the constants, h, and k. In the experiment displayed in Figures 17 and 18, Gj and G2 were measured with a GluCath sensor at four temperatures (15 °C, 25 °C, 37 °C, and 45 °C) and four pH levels (6.8, 7.0, 7.4, 7.6), all at a glucose concentration of 100 mg/dL. Note that Figures 17 and 18 demonstrate, among other things, that the G1 and G2 fluorescent signals are effected by temperature change, even when the pH level is held constant. Figure 19 shows the ratio of the measured values of Gx and G2 from Figures 17 and 18 plotted versus pH at each of the four temperatures. A line was fit (using linear regression) to each series of G G2 values corresponding to the same temperature. Figure 19 illustrates that the intercepts of these lines, and to a lesser extent the slopes of these lines, vary with temperature. To model this temperature dependence, the associated slopes and intercepts are plotted as functions of temperature in Figure 20. Equation 10 was used to model the temperature dependence of the slope m H , and based on the data displayed in Figure 20 best fit values of the constants h, and i were determined. Similarly, Equation 11 was used to model the temperature dependence of the intercept β H , and based on the data displayed in Figure 20 best fit values of the constants j, and k were determined. The best fit values of h, and k to be used in Equation 12 are listed in Table 3.
Figure imgf000073_0001
[0220] An independent data set was generated to test the accuracy of using Equation 12 to compute pH level from measured Gl/G2 ratio, using these values of h, and k. Figure 21 displays both measured reference pH values (small and medium sized dots) and values of pH computed from G /G2 with Equation 12 (sequence of 'x' marks)— at two temperatures (30 °C, and 40 °C) and two glucose levels (50 mg/dL and 100 mg/dL). Note that the medium sized dot (corresponding to a glucose concentration of 100 mg/dL and pH 7.4) served as the reference point for the one-point calibration as described above. The results are displayed in the following table. As indicated in Table 4, the average pH offset for this data set was +0.008.
Figure imgf000074_0001
Methods of Estimating Analyte Concentration Incorporating pH Correction
[0221] Some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein generate a signal indicative of analyte concentration which exhibits a pH dependence. For example, if two solutions of precisely the same analyte concentration are measured at two different pH levels with the same measurement device, in some embodiments, the measurement device may generate differing signals indicative of the two analyte concentrations. Thus, the accuracy of determining a solution's true analyte concentration based on such as signal may be improved by taking the pH of the solution into account.
[0222] It has been discovered that for some embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein, and in particular, for glucose measurement devices employing a quencher binding moiety operably coupled to a fluorophore, the pH dependence of the fluorescent signal approximately follows a modified version of the classic Michaelis-Menten equation from enzyme kinetics:
(Equation 13)
Figure imgf000074_0002
where:
[Gl ] is the estimated glucose concentration,
apH is the first Michaelis-Menten parameter "a", at a particular pH, b H is the second Michaelis-Menten parameter "b", at the same particular pH, c H is the third Michaelis-Menten parameter "c", at the same particular pH, and
G, is the fluorescent signal (z = 1,2) , either referenced or unreferenced, where G1 is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 470nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's base-form), and G2 is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 420nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's acid-form). Note, however, that other combinations of excitation and emission wavelengths are also feasible for use in Equation 13. In the Examples below, G2 has been used, unless indicated otherwise.
[0223] As with temperature dependence, the fact that pH dependence may be described by a modified Michaelis-Menten equation is an interesting and surprising result. Various embodiments of the measurement devices disclosed herein employ a quencher- fluorophore indicator system which measures analyte concentration through the establishment of an equilibrium between the analyte of interest, the binding moiety (e.g. quencher), and the fluorophore. In such a system, analyte concentration is not measured by enzymatic consumption or conversion of the analyte. In contrast, the classic Michaelis-Menten equation specifically describes enzyme kinetics, a non-equilibrium phenomena involving the consumption/conversion of the enzyme's substrate by the enzyme. Therefore, it is not to be expected that an equation closely related to the classic Michaelis-Menten equation would effectively describe the pH dependence of these types of quencher-fluorophore-based measurement devices and analyte sensing elements (or other measurement devices and analyte sensing elements functioning through analogous equilibrium mechanisms). In any event, knowledge that these devices (and similar devices) exhibit a pH dependence which follows a modified Michaelis-Menten equation allows the use of pH correction methods and algorithms to improve the accuracy of analyte concentration measurements. Such methods and algorithms are disclosed herein, along with measurement devices which implement such methods and algorithms.
[0224] Accordingly, some embodiment methods of estimating an analyte concentration include generating a signal indicative of analyte concentration and a signal indicative of pH. In some embodiments, the signal indicative of the analyte concentration and the signal indicative of the pH are both generated from a set of at least two signals each of which is indicative of both the pH and the analyte concentration. For instance, these could be the G, and G2 fluorescent signals described above, both of which are indicative of both analyte concentration and pH. In some embodiments, the G2 fluorescent signal itself may be treated as the signal indicative of analyte concentration, while G1 and G2 are used as signals indicative of pH, for example, in the pH determination algorithm described above. Since, in some embodiments, the signal indicative of analyte concentration exhibits a pH dependence, in some embodiments, the signal indicative of pH may be used to adjust the signal indicative of analyte concentration to correct for pH dependence. Thus, in certain such embodiments, the methods further include transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation, such as Equation 1 above, depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, such as the parameters "a", "6", and "c", as described above as first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters with reference to Equation 13.
[0225] Of course, it is to be understood that when a signal is described herein as being indicative of one physical quantity, such description is not meant to necessarily preclude that signal from also being indicative of another physical quantity. For instance, a computed analyte concentration that may be improved through pH correction, was likely computed from a signal indicative of analyte concentration which contained some pH dependency. Therefore, to a certain extent, such a signal indicative of analyte concentration may also be considered a signal indicative of pH, as will be readily appreciated by one of skill in the art.
[0226] The pH dependence of Equation 13 is exhibited through the Michaelis-Menten parameters apH, bpn, and cpH, as indicated by the subscript "pH" labeling these parameters. In some embodiments, the pH dependence may need to be determined through a pH calibration. Thus, in certain embodiment methods, the values of one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based on data which includes pH calibration data and the signal indicative of a pH.
[0227] For example, in some embodiment methods, the pH calibration data may be generated by a pH calibration method. The pH calibration method may include selecting a first test analyte sensing element, and creating and/or providing a set of at least three solutions of differing known analyte concentrations. In certain such embodiments, a first pH is selected (pHl), three solutions of the set of at least three solutions are adjusted to a pH substantially similar to the selected first pH, and a first set of at least three signals is generated using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different one of the three solutions at the first pH. Measurements are then made at a second pH. Thus, in certain embodiments, a second pH is selected (pH2), three solutions of the set of at least three solutions (each of the three may be the same or different than a solution chosen for the first pH) are adjusted to a pH substantially similar to the selected second pH, and a second set of at least three signals is generated using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different one of the three solutions at the second pH. Of course, more than three solutions may be used in either of these steps. And more than two pHs may also be employed. Generally, the more solutions of differing concentration and the greater number of different pHs that are employed, the greater the accuracy of the resulting calibration data.
[0228] Once the solutions having known analyte concentrations have been measured, and the first and second sets of at least three signals have been generated, in some embodiments, the sets of signals are used to determine (usually approximately) the relationship between one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters and pH. For example, in some embodiments, the pH calibration method may further include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH {apm, bpHi, and cpHi) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a first fit dataset comprising the first set of at least three signals. In certain such embodiments, the pH calibration method may further include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH (apm, bPH2, and cpH2) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a second fit dataset comprising the second set of at least three signals. Thus, in methods such as these, each of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters has been determined at least two pHs, providing data which may be used to create a model of the pH dependence of each of the three Michaelis-Menten parameters.
[0229] To model the pH dependence of the Michaelis-Menten parameters, in some embodiments, the pH calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the first Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH, the equation depending on a first set of pH calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the first set of calibration parameters based on the value of the first Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH (aPm) and the value of the first Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH (<¾,.¾)· In some embodiments, similar steps are performed with respect to the second and third Michaelis-Menten parameters (bpn and cpH). Thus, for example, the pH calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the second Michaelis-Menten parameter (Z /) to pH, the equation depending on a second set of pH calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the second set of calibration parameters based on the value of the second Michaelis- Menten parameter at the first pH (¾#;) and the value of the second Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH (¾)· Similarly, in some embodiments, the pH calibration method may further include selecting an equation relating the third Michaelis-Menten parameter (CPH) to pH, the equation depending on a third set of pH calibration parameters; and setting a value for each calibration parameter of the third set of calibration parameters based on the value of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH (cpH]) and the value of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH {cPH2)-
[0230] Furthermore, in some embodiments, equations linear in pH may be selected to relate the first and second Michaelis-Menten parameters to pH, while a more complicated equation may be selected to relate the third Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH. For instance, in some embodiments, the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters may be written as
Figure imgf000078_0001
bPH = biA * PbpH ipH) > and (Equation 14)
CpH = ClA * PcpH (j>H)
where pa /i {pH), pb ji (pH), and pC i (pH) are "pH correction factors" which approximately account for the pH dependence of apH, bpH, and cpH. When the relationship between Michaelis- Menten parameter and pH is written as such, each Michaelis-Menten parameter apn, bpn, and CPH, is determined by multiplying the pH 7.4 Michael is-Menten parameter a . , b7.4, and c7.4, by its corresponding "pH correction factor," pa ij (pH), pb w (pH), or pC fj (pH), respectively. The pH
7.4 Michaelis-Menten parameters may be determined by fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a set of signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a plurality of solutions of differing analyte concentrations held at pH 7.4, as described above with respect to, for example, pHl and pH2. Alternatively, the parameters a7.4, b 4, and c7.4 may be supplied by a factory calibration as described in provisional U.S. patent application No. 61/184,747, "Algorithms for Calibrating an Analyte Sensor," filed June 5, 2009, which is hereby incorporated herein by reference in its entirety. As yet another alternative, 4, b 4, and c 4 may be determine via a one-point in vivo calibration as also disclosed in the same application.
[0231] To determine the "pH correction factors," pa H {pH), pb H (pH), pc H {pH), some embodiment methods may select a first equation linear in pH to relate the first Michaelis- Menten parameter to pH, and select a second equation linear in pH to relate the second Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH. In certain such embodiment methods, an equation is selected to relate the third Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH which comprises a fraction wherein the numerator is equal to an exponential function of an equation linear in the inverse of pH, and the denominator is equal to an exponential function of the same linear function in the inverse of pH evaluated at pH 7.4. If such equations in pH are selected, then the pH correction factors may be written as
(Equation 15)
Figure imgf000079_0001
where the slopes, ma h , mb h , mc h , and intercepts, βα H , ¾ H , βα H , are collectively referred to as pH calibration coefficients ("pHCos"). However, analytic functional forms other than linear equations may be chosen to relate the pH correction factors and/or Michaelis-Menten parameters to pH (or to inverses of pH as indicated by Equation 15's expression for pc (pH)). For instance, in some embodiments, quadratic or higher-order polynomials in pH may be appropriate and/or desirable.
[0232] In various embodiments, a pH calibration method used to determine values of these pHCos may require that values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters be determined at a second pH (pH2), different than pH 7.4. Values of the parameters at the second pH (ap , bpm, and Cpui) may be determined by fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a set of signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a plurality of solutions of differing analyte concentrations held at the second pH, as described above with respect to, for example, pHl and pH2. Once this is done, the pH calibration coefficients ma h and βα h may be determined by normalizing to 07,4 both aPH2 and 07,4, yielding apH2/ 74 and 1, and fitting a line to the normalized values versus the two pHs, pH2 and pH 7.4. The fit may be determined using linear least squares or any other method of fitting a line to a set of points. The pH calibration coefficient, ma h , is set equal to the slope of the resulting line and the pH calibration coefficient, βα H , is set equal to the intercept. The pH calibration coefficients mb h and ¾ h may be determined the same way from values of bpm and £7.4. Finally, in a manner analogous to the determination of m„ , Bn , m, , and β, , the pH calibration coefficients m and ? may be determined from values of cPH2 and C7.4, however an additional step of linearizing Equation 15's expression for pc h (pH) must first be performed. Once the calibration is complete, a pH corrected estimated glucose concentration ( [G/W] ) may be computed from a fluorescent signal ( G, ) measured at a particular pH, by using the pHCos (τηα≠ , βαρΗ , mbfH , βΒρΗ , mCpH , and β^ ), the pH 7.4 Michaelis-Menten parameters (07.4, b . , and C7.4), and the measured pH (pH) in Equations 14 and 15 to compute apn, bpn, and cpH, and then plugging apH, bpH, cpH and the measured fluorescent signal (G, ) into Equation 13.
[0233] Thus, in some embodiments, the first set of pH calibration parameters comprises the slope and intercept of a first equation linear in pH, and in some embodiments, the second set of pH calibration parameters comprises the slope and intercept of a second equation linear in pH. In certain such embodiments, the third set of pH calibration parameters may comprise the slope and intercept of an equation linear in the inverse of pH which is related to the third Michaelis-Menten parameter through an exponential function divided by a constant— wherein the constant is equal to the result of evaluating the exponential function of the same equation linear in the inverse of pH evaluated at a fixed pH level. However, the pH calibration parameters (pHCos) may comprise constants associated with analytic functional forms other than linear equations which may be suitable and/or desirable. For instance, in some embodiments, the pHCos may include the coefficients of quadratic or higher-order polynomials in pH.
[0234] When measurement devices are mass produced, it may not be feasible or practical to individually calibrate each measurement device— i.e. use each individual measurement device to generate individual calibration data. It may be more cost effective to select one or more test devices from a batch of mass produced devices, generate calibration data using the one or more test devices, and provide that calibration data to each individual devices produced in the batch. In some embodiments, variability between measurement devices from the same production batch may be, to a large extent, attributable to a particular part of the measurement device. In particular, variability between devices may be attributable to the part of the measurement device which generates a signal indicative of analyte concentration— e.g. the analyte sensing element— and/or the part of the measurement device that generates a signal indicative of pH— e.g. the pH sensing element. In these circumstances, as well as others, it may be advantageous to use a calibration method employing multiple test measurement devices, and/or multiple test sensing elements, because calibration over multiple test devices and/or sensing elements may yield more accurate calibration data than calibration methods which only utilize a single test device and/or sensing element. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the calibration method may further include selecting a second test analyte sensing element; generating a third set of at least three signals using the second test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of known analyte concentration at the first pH ipHl); and generating a fourth set of at least three signals using the second test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of known analyte concentration at the second pH (pH2). Obviously, calibration methods may similarly employ more than two test devices, or more particularly, for instance, more than two test analyte sensing elements.
[0235] In a manner similar to methods utilizing a single test analyte sensing element, after the solutions having known analyte concentrations have been measured and the first, second, third, and fourth sets of at least three signals have been generated, in some embodiments, the sets of signals are used to determine (usually approximately) the relationship between one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters and pH. For example, in some embodiments, the pH calibration method may further include (1) computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH (apm, bpni, and CPHI) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a first fit dataset comprising both the first set of at least three signals (which was generated with the first test analyte sensing element at pHl) and the third set of at least three signals (which was generated with the second test analyte sensing element at pHl); and (2) computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH (<¾,/#, bpm, and cp/#) by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a second fit dataset comprising both the second set of at least three signals (which was generated with the first test analyte sensing element at pH2) and fourth set of at least three signals (which was generated with the second test analyte sensing element at pH2). Essentially, in these types of methods, the signals generated with the second test analyte sensing element are used in a combined fit with the signals generated with the first test analyte sensing element, which results in values for each of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters which take both test analyte sensing elements into account. Alternatively, in some embodiments, a pH calibration method may take both test analyte sensing elements into account by fitting the signals generated from each test analyte sensing element separately, and then averaging the results to obtain better estimates of the Michaelis-Menten parameters. Thus, in some embodiments, the step of computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis- Menten parameter at the first pH {apm, bPHi, and CP J) by an algorithm may further include fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a third fit dataset comprising the third set of at least three signals, and averaging the results of fitting the third fit dataset with the results of fitting the first fit dataset. In addition, the step of computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH {apm, bPH2, and CPET) by an algorithm may further include fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a fourth fit dataset comprising the fourth set of at least three signals, and averaging the results of fitting the fourth fit dataset with the results of fitting the second fit dataset.
[0236] Other methods for estimating analyte concentration which incorporate pH correction features and pH calibration steps are also disclosed herein. In some embodiments, these methods are similar to those already described above and incorporate similar features, however, additional features may also be disclosed and, in some embodiments, the disclosed methods may be more general and described in more general terms. Since there are many ways to feasibly implement the discoveries disclosed herein for use in estimating analyte concentration, the following additional methods are described in order to illustrate the breadth of implementations that are possible.
[0237] In some embodiments, for instance, a method of estimating an analyte concentration from a signal indicative of the analyte concentration may include transforming the signal using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein the values of one or more Michaelis-Menten parameters have been adjusted for pH.
[0238] In some embodiments, for instance, a method of estimating an analyte concentration may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration and generating a signal indicative of a pH, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more pH calibration parameters and the signal indicative of pH. One could refer to such an equation as a "substituted" modified Michaelis- Menten equation since the Michaelis-Menten parameters have been explicitly substituted with equations depending on one or more other variables— pH and the pH calibration parameters. However, although such a "substituted" equation exhibits a more complicated analytic form, it nevertheless will still express the basic functional relationships of the modified Michaelis- Menten equation.
[0239] In some embodiments, the step of transforming the signal indicative of analyte concentration may utilize a "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation in which each of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters have been substituted with first, second, and third calibration equations (respectively), each of the equations depending on sets of first, second, and third pH calibration parameters (respectively), and each also depending on the signal indicative of pH. In certain embodiments, at least one of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a polynomial in the signal indicative of pH. In certain such embodiments, each of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a polynomial in the signal indicative of pH. In certain embodiments, at least one of the first, second, and third calibration equations is a linear equation in the signal indicative of pH. In certain such embodiments, the first and second calibration equations are a linear equations in the signal indicative of pH, and the third calibration equation comprises a fraction wherein the numerator is equal to an exponential function of an equation linear in the inverse of the signal indicative of pH, and the denominator is equal to an exponential function of the same linear function in the inverse of the signal indicative of pH evaluated at fixed pH.
[0240] Thus, for example, if each Michaelis-Menten parameter of Equation 13 above is assumed to exhibit a linear relationship with pH, then the "substituted" modified Michaelis- Menten equation might appear as
(Equation 16)
Figure imgf000084_0001
and, similarly, if each Michaelis-Menten parameter is assumed to exhibit a quadratic relationship with pH then the "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation might appear as
Figure imgf000084_0002
(Equation 17) where:
[Gl ] is the estimated glucose concentration,
Za H 2 > Xa H \ > and Za„ o are polynomial coefficients parameterizing ap// 's dependence on the pH level,
Xb H 2 > and Xb„ o are polynomial coefficients parameterizing bpH 's dependence on the pH level,
Xc j, 2 ' Xc„ l > an<^ Xc„ o are polynomial coefficients parameterizing cpH 's dependence on the pH level, and
G, is the fluorescent signal ( = 1,2) , either referenced or unreferenced, where G, is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 470nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's base-form), and G2 is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 420nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's acid-form). Note, however, that other combinations of excitation and emission wavelengths are also feasible for use in Equations 16 and 17.
[0241] As stated above, although, the "substituted" equations (Equations 16 and 17) exhibit a more complicated analytic form, they nevertheless still exhibit the basic functional relationships of the modified Michaelis-Menten equation (Equation 13). In other embodiments, the calibration equations substituted into the modified Michaelis-Menten equation may have a functional form other than a polynomial in pH.
[0242] Thus, as described above, the calibration equations substituted into the modified Michaelis-Menten equation for the Michaelis-Menten parameters may take a variety of functional forms and each may have varying numbers of pH calibration parameters. Obviously, more complicated equations may have a greater numbers of pH calibration parameters. In any event, depending on the embodiment, various pH calibration methods may be used to determine the values of the first, secondh and third sets of the one or more pH calibration parameters. In certain such embodiments, each set of pH calibration parameters may be determined by fitting the "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a plurality of signals, the plurality of signals indicative of analyte concentration in a plurality of solutions at a plurality of pHs. Once values of the various pH calibration parameters are determined, pH corrected estimates of analyte concentrations may be generated from signals indicative of analyte concentration and pH.
Example 4
[0243] This example concerns the pH calibration of an equilibrium fluorescence glucose GluCath sensor. Again, the GluCath sensor employs an HPTS-Cys-MA dye operably coupled to a 3,3'-oBBV quencher, with the dye and quencher immobilized within a hydrogel disposed along the distal region of an optical fiber, while the proximal end of the optical fiber is coupled to a light source. The pH dependence of this sensor's fluorescence response to glucose was assumed to approximately follow the modified Michaelis-Menten equation labeled as Equation 13 and described above. The Michaelis-Menten a H , bpH , and cpH parameters were assumed to bear the relationships to pH set forth in Equations 14 and 15 above. Thus, the a H and b H Michaelis-Menten parameters were assumed to depend linearly on pH, while the cpH
Michaelis-Menten parameter was assumed to obey an exponential relationship to the inverse of pH as set forth in Equation 14's expression for cpH and Equation 15's expression for pc h (pH). Using this model of the glucose sensor's pH dependence, the pH calibration coefficients, ma h , B„ , mh , ¾ , w„ , and ?„ , were determined by the methodology described above in reference to Equations 14 and 15.
[0244] Specifically, the effect of pH on the fluorescent signal was determined experimentally by measuring the signal at five pH levels (6.8, 7.0, 7.2, 7.4, and 7.6) and four glucose concentrations (50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL). At each pH and glucose level, the stable fluorescent signals j and G2 were recorded, as displayed in Figure 22. Figure 22 illustrates that the data corresponding to a fixed glucose concentration of 100 mg/dL exhibits the lowest fluorescent intensity at the lowest pH (pH 6.8), and the highest fluorescent intensity at the highest pH (pH 7.6)— and, more generally, that the intensity increases monotonically as a function of pH. However, the modulation due to glucose changes inversely with pH— that is, the modulation (the ratio of fluorescent intensity at high glucose concentration versus low glucose concentration) is lowest at high pH and highest at low pH. Values of the stable fluorescent signal G2 taken from Figure 22 are replotted in Figure 23 versus glucose concentration— each curve corresponding to a fixed pH level. Since the five constant-pH curves in Figure 23 are generally non-overlapping, it is clear that changes in pH level have an effect on the G2 fluorescent signal. From this data, values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters, apH, bpn, and CpH (specifically, a6 S , a1 0 , 7 2 , a1A , a1 6 , b6 s , b10 , b1 2 , b1A , b16 , c6 S , c70 , c7 2 , c74 , and c76 ), were computed using Equation 13, see Figure 24, and normalized to their values at pH 7.4, see Figure 25. Figures 24 and 25 illustrate that values of the first and second Michaelis-Menten parameters, apn and bpn, respectively, vary approximately linearly with pH level, while the value of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter, cpH, exhibits some degree of non-linear variation with pH. Hence, Equations 14 and 15 were chosen to model apn, bPH, and CPH, as described above.
[0245] This process for determining values of apH, bpH, and CPH was repeated over two additional glucose sensors of the same design as the first to generate a calibration with improved accuracy. Thus, fluorescent signals were generated with each of the two additional glucose sensors, at each of the same five pH levels (6.8, 7.0, 7.2, 7.4, and 7.6) and four glucose concentrations (50 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, 200 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL). This data corresponding to each of the two additional glucose sensors was fit with Equations 14 and 15 (as was done with the initial sensor) in order to generate values of a6 & , a1 0 , a *77.22 ,' a "7.4 ' "7.6 ' ^ "66..88 ' ^ "77..00 '' ^ "77..22 '' ^ "77..44 » b7 6 , c6 g , c70 , c12 , c74 , and c76 for each additional glucose sensor. The data from the additional two glucose sensors was averaged together with the data from the first sensor to generate averaged values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters, a6 g , 70 , a1 2 , a1 , a1 6 , b6 g , b1 7.Q0 ,' b ^n7.2 ' ^7.4 ' ^7.6 ' C6.8 ' C7.0 ' C7.2 ' C7.4 , and 7.6
[0246] Determination of the pH calibration parameters corresponding to Equations 14 and 15 was done using these averaged values. Thus, the pH calibration parameters corresponding to the "a" Michaelis-Menten parameter— i.e. ma h and βα h— were determined by normalizing each of the "a" parameters to a74 , and fitting a line (again using linear least squares) to a plot of these values— i.e. 6874 , α7074 , α7274 , 1 , ο7674 versus pH— the slope and intercept being ma h and βα h , respectively. The same was done with the pH calibration parameters mb h and b n , corresponding to the "b" Michaelis-Menten parameter, and mc h and β0 h , corresponding to the "c" Michaelis-Menten parameter. The resulting empirically derived values for these pH calibration coefficients (pHCos) are summarized in Table 5 below:
Figure imgf000087_0001
Methods of Estimating Analyte Concentration Incoφoratin Temperature and pH Correction
[0247] In the preceding disclosure, various methods and/or algorithms are described for correcting a signal indicative of analyte concentration, independently for the effects of temperature, and independently for the effects of pH. It has also been discovered that various aspects of these methods and/or algorithms may be incorporated into combination algorithms and/or methods which correct for both the pH and temperature dependence of signals indicative of analyte concentration. Similarly to what was discovered with respect to correction for temperature and pH level, it has been found that a modified Michaelis-Menten equation can also be used as an analytical model to take both temperature and pH dependence into account simultaneously. Thus, temperature and pH dependence may be modeled in combination with an equation analogous to Equations 1 and 13 described above:
[Glu] = J (Equat.on i ^ αΤ,ρΗ + ^Τ,ρΗ where:
[Glu] is the estimated glucose concentration, aT pH is the first Michaelis-Menten parameter "a", at a particular temperature and pH, bT pH is the second Michaelis-Menten parameter "b", at the same particular temperature and pH,
cT,pH ls me mird Michaelis-Menten parameter "c", at the same particular temperature and pH, and
G(. is the fluorescent signal (/ = 1,2) , either referenced or unreferenced, where Gl is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 470nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore' s base-form), and G2 is the fluorescence emission at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 420nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's acid-form). Note, however, that other combinations of excitation and emission wavelengths are also feasible for use in Equation 18. In the Examples below, G2 has been used, unless indicated otherwise.
[0248] Accordingly, some embodiment methods of estimating an analyte concentration include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration, a signal indicative of a temperature, and a signal indicative of a pH. In some embodiments, the signal indicative of the analyte concentration and the signal indicative of the pH are both generated from a set of at least two signals each of which is indicative of both the pH and the analyte concentration. For instance, these could be the Gj and G2 fluorescent signals described above, both of which are indicative of both analyte concentration and pH. In some embodiments, the G2 fluorescent signal itself may be treated as the signal indicative of analyte concentration, while G, and G2 are used as signals indicative of pH, for example, in the pH determination algorithm described above. Furthermore, in some embodiments, the signal indicative of the analyte concentration, the signal indicative of the temperature, and the signal indicative of the pH are each generated from a set of at least three signals each of which is indicative of the temperature, the pH, and the analyte concentration. Since, in some embodiments, the signal indicative of the analyte concentration exhibits a temperature dependence and a pH dependence which may be quantitatively characterized by a modified Michaelis-Menten equation (as described above), methods accomplishing temperature and pH correction may further include transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation, such as Equation 18 above, depending on Michaelis- Menten parameters, such as the parameters " ", "b", and "c", as described above as first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters with reference to Equation 18.
[0249] The temperature and pH dependence of Equation 18 is exhibited through the Michaelis-Menten parameters aT pH , bT pH , and cT pH , as indicated by the subscripts "I" and
"pH" labeling these parameters. In some embodiments, the temperature and pH dependence may need to be determined through a calibration method. Thus, in certain embodiment methods, the values of one or more of the Michaelis-Menten parameters may be set based on data which includes temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of temperature, and the signal indicative of a pH.
[0250] In some embodiment methods, the temperature and pH calibration parameters may be determined by a calibration method. The calibration method may include selecting a first test analyte sensing element, selecting three differing concentrations of analyte, selecting a first temperature (77) and a second temperature (72) (the second differing from the first), and selecting a first pH ipHl) and a second pH (pH2) (the second differing from the first). Once these selections are made, the calibration method may include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the selected first temperature (77). This computation may employ an algorithm which includes fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the selected three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the selected first temperature (77). The three signals may be generated, for example, by using the first test analyte sensing element to measure the concentration of analyte in each solution of a set of three solutions, each of which has been prepared so as to contain one of the three selected concentrations of analyte adjusted to the first selected temperature (Tl).
[0251] Calculations are then performed with respect to the selected second temperature (T2), analogously to those employed with respect to the selected first temperature (Tl). Thus, the calibration method may include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the selected second temperature (T2). This computation may employ an algorithm which includes fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the selected three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the selected second temperature (T2). The three signals may be generated, for example, by using the first test analyte sensing element to measure the concentration of analyte in each solution of a set of three solutions, each of which has been prepared so as to contain one of the three selected concentrations of analyte adjusted to the second selected temperature (T2).
[0252] To account for pH effects, the calibration method may include computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the selected first pH level ipHl) and the selected second pH level (pH2). The computation with respect to the selected first pH level (pHl) may employ an algorithm which includes fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the selected three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the selected first pH level (pHl). The three signals may be generated, for example, by using the first test analyte sensing element to measure the concentration of analyte in each solution of a set of three solutions, each of which has been prepared so as to contain one of the three selected concentrations of analyte adjusted to the first selected pH level (pHl). Similarly, the computation with respect to the selected second pH level (pH2) may employ an algorithm which includes fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the selected three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the selected second pH level ipH2). The three signals may be generated, for example, by using the second test analyte sensing element to measure the concentration of analyte in each solution of a set of three solutions, each of which has been prepared so as to contain one of the three selected concentrations of analyte adjusted to the second selected pH level (pH2).
[0253] Note that though the above described computation uses three selected analyte concentrations to compute values of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters at two temperatures and two pH levels, one of ordinary skill in the art will readily appreciate that more than three selected concentrations may be also be used. Generally, employing greater numbers of selected analyte concentrations will produce more accurate values of the Michaelis- Menten parameters at the various temperatures and pH levels. Furthermore, in some embodiments, it may be advantageous to compute the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters at more than two temperatures and more than two pH levels, as will become apparent to one of ordinary skill in the art from the discussion that follows.
[0254] From values of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters at two or more temperatures (aTi, bTi, CTI, τ2, bj2, and c¾) and two or more pH levels (apm, bpni, CpHi, aP , bPH2, and cPH2), a relationship between each Michaelis-Menten parameter and temperature and pH may be determined. Thus, in some embodiments, a first calibration equation is selected to relate the first Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH. In some embodiments, the equation may depend on a first set of temperature and pH calibration parameters. In certain such embodiments, a value for each parameter is set based on the values of the first Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature ( Tj), the second temperature the first pH (apm), and the second pH (<¾,/¾)· Similarly, in some embodiments, a second calibration equation is selected to relate the second Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH. In some embodiments, the equation may depend on a second set of temperature and pH calibration parameters. In certain such embodiments, a value for each parameter is set based on the values of the second Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (bn), the second temperature (^2), the first pH (bPHi), and the second pH (bPE2)- Finally, in some embodiments, a third calibration equation is selected to relate the third Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH. In some embodiments, the equation may depend on a third set of temperature and pH calibration parameters. In certain such embodiments, a value for each parameter is set based on the values of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature (cjj), the second temperature (c^), the first pH (CP I), and the second pH (CPH2)-
[0255] A calibration equation which is selected to relate one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters to temperature and pH may consist of any functional relationship which satisfactorily relates the parameter to temperature and pH once the equation's calibration parameters (if any) are determined. Suitable calibration equations include analytic functions such as polynomial functions in temperature and pH. However, the phrase "calibration equation" is used herein to generally denote any functional relationship between one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters and temperature and pH. Thus, for example, a lookup table specifying a value of any Michaelis- Menten parameter based on particular values of temperature and pH is considered a "calibration equation" as that phrase is used herein. A set of multiple analytic functions which individually apply over particular ranges of temperatures and pHs is also considered a "calibration equation" as that phrase is used herein.
[0256] In some calibration methods, the first calibration equation (i.e. selected to relate the first Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH) comprises a product of a first pH-independent function and a first temperature-independent function. One of ordinary skill in the art will readily appreciate that, in some embodiments, using functions which satisfy this criteria may simplify the analysis somewhat, however, such a person of ordinary skill would also appreciate that such a criteria is not essential to the operation of the general methods disclosed herein. The same criteria may also apply to the second and third calibration equations. Thus, in some embodiments, the second calibration equation is the product of a second pH-independent function and a second temperature-independent function, and the third calibration equation is the product of a third pH-independent function and a third temperature-independent function. In some embodiments, calibration equations meeting these criteria may be represented by the following expression:
Figure imgf000092_0001
PH = bo * HT {T)* Pbpf! ipH) (Equation 19) cT,PH = K * cT {T)* pCpH {pH) where:
τατ (τ), 7^ ( ), and TCt (T) are "temperature correction factors" which approximately account for the temperature dependence of aT pH , bT pH , and cT pH ; pa H (pH), pb fi (pH), and pc ^ pH) are "pH correction factors" which approximately account for the pH dependence of aT pH , bT pH , and cT pH ; and 0 , b0 , c0 are constants set equal to the value of aT pH , bT pH , and cT pH determined at a particular selected standard temperature and pH level. [0257] When the temperature and pH dependence of each Michaelis-Menten parameter is expressed in the form of Equation 19, each Michaelis-Menten parameter, aT pH , bT pH , cT pH , is determined by multiplying its value at the selected standard temperature and pH level, aQ , bQ , c0 , by its corresponding "temperature correction factor," ταγ {τ), TCT (T), and by multiplying again by its corresponding "pH correction factor," pa H ( >H), pb ft (pH), pc h (pH) (of course, the order of multiplication is irrelevant when the temperature and pH dependence are modeled in this manner). The standard temperature and pH Michaelis-Menten parameters, a0 , bQ , c0 , may be determined by fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a set of signals indicative of the analyte concentration of a plurality of solutions of differing analyte concentrations held at the selected standard temperature and pH level. Alternatively, the parameters aQ , b0 , and c0 may be supplied by a factory calibration as described in provisional
U.S. patent application No. 61/184,747, "Algorithms for Calibrating an Analyte Sensor," filed June 5, 2009, which is hereby incorporated herein by reference in its entirety. As yet another alternative, a0 , b0 , and c0 may be determine via a one-point in vivo calibration as also disclosed in the same application.
[0258] Furthermore, in some embodiments, the first, second, and third pH- independent functions may be selected so as to be linear in temperature; the first and second temperature-independent functions may be selected so as to be linear in pH; and the third temperature-independent function may be selected to be a fraction wherein the numerator is equal to an exponential function of a third function linear in the inverse of pH, and the denominator is equal to an exponential function of the same function linear in the inverse of pH evaluated at pH 7.4. Calibration equations satisfying these criteria may be written as:
TbT (T) = ¾ * T + br ; (Equation 3) rCr(r)= ¾ *r + £r (Equation 15)
Figure imgf000094_0001
[0259] These equations, as indicated by their numbering, are identical to the equations discussed above with respect to separate temperature calibration and pH calibration. Thus, in methods employing these equations, the first set of temperature and pH calibration parameters comprise the slope and intercept of the first pH-independent function and the slope and intercept of the first temperature independent function. Similarly, the second set of temperature and pH calibration parameters comprise the slope and intercept of the second pH- independent function and the slope and intercept of the second temperature independent function, and the third set of temperature and pH calibration parameters comprise the slope and intercept of the third pH-independent function and the slope and intercept of the third function linear in the signal indicative of pH.
[0260] Since the calibration equations selected to represent the temperature and pH correction factors match those separately employed above with respect to temperature and pH correction, the TempCos (mar , βατ , m^ , β^ , mCr , and β^ ) and pHCos ( w^ , βΒ/Η , mbpH ,
J3b fl , mc h , and β0 h ) determined above separately with respect to temperature and pH may be used in Equation 19, provided that a0 , bQ , and bQ are determined in a manner consistent with the determination of the 37 °C Michaelis-Menten parameters, a37, bn, C37, and the pH 7.4 Michaelis- Menten parameters, a7.4, b7.4, c7.4. For instance, if aQ , b0 , and c0 are determined at 37 °C and pH 7.4, then these constants may be consistently relabeled α37 74 , £37 74 , and c37 74 , and the
TempCos and pHCos determined above separately with respect to temperature and pH may be used in Equation 19. Therefore, an expression for computing a temperature and pH corrected glucose concentration may be given by (EqUatl°n
Figure imgf000095_0001
where:
[GIU] is the estimated glucose concentration, aT pH , bT pH , and cT pH are the Michaelis-Menten parameters, at a particular temperature and pH,
7 74 , £37 74, and c37 74 are the Michaelis-Menten parameters determined at 37 °C and pH 7.4,
T aT (T) > ^ (τ), cT (T)> PapH ipH), PbpH {pH), and PCpH pH) are given by Equations 3 and 15, and
G2 is the fluorescent emission, either referenced or unreferenced, at 550nm when the fluorophore is excited at 420nm (which is the absorption maximum of the fluorophore's acid-form). Note, however, that other combinations of excitation and emission wavelengths are also feasible for use in Equation 20. In Example 5 below, G2 has been used.
Example 5
[0261] This example concerns the simultaneous temperature and pH calibration of an equilibrium fluorescence glucose GluCath sensor, and an assessment of the accuracy of the calibration by comparison with an independent data set. Again, the GluCath sensor employs an HPTS-Cys-MA dye operably coupled to a 3,3'-oBBV quencher, with the dye and quencher immobilized within a hydrogel disposed along the distal region of an optical fiber, while the proximal end of the optical fiber is coupled to a light source. The temperature and pH dependence of this sensor's fluorescence response to glucose was assumed to approximately follow Equation 20— using the TempCos from Table 2 and the pHCos from Table 5. The 37 °C, pH 7.4 Michaelis-Menten parameters, a37 74 , bJ1 74 , c31 74 , appearing in Equation 20 were determined by averaging data over multiple sensors derived from fitting a modified Michaelis- Menten equation to three solutions having known glucose concentrations of 0 mg/dL, 100 mg/dL, and 400 mg/dL, followed by a single measurement at 100 mg/dL using the individual sensor to adjust the parameters to the individual sensor. [0262] To test the calibration, measurements were made on two different glucose solution concentrations (50 mg/dL and 100 mg/dL), at two different temperatures (30 °C and 40 °Q, and at two different pH levels (pH 7.400 and pH 7.035). Reference measurements were made using the Yellow Springs Instrument glucose oxidase lab analyzer ("YSI"), the gold standard of blood glucose measurements. The results are displayed in Figure 26, Figure 27 (which displays a zoomed-in portion of Figure 26), and Table 6 below. In particular, Table 6 lists the predicted glucose concentration compared to the YSI reference measurements before correction, and after temperature and pH correction using Equation 20. The mean absolute relative deviation ("MARD") between the temperature and pH corrected glucose concentrations and the reference glucose concentration was only 5.0%, while the MARD for the same data set without temperature and pH correction was 29.6%.
Figure imgf000096_0001
Other Related Methods of Incorporating Temperature and pH Correction
[0263] Other methods for estimating analyte concentration which incorporate temperature and pH correction features and temperature and pH calibration steps are also disclosed herein. In some embodiments, these methods are similar to those already described above and incorporate similar features, however, additional features may also be disclosed and, in some embodiments, the disclosed methods may be more general and described in more general terms. Since there are many ways to feasibly implement the discoveries disclosed herein for use in estimating analyte concentration, the following additional methods are described in order to illustrate the breadth of implementations that are possible.
[0264] In some embodiments, for instance, a method of estimating an analyte concentration from a signal indicative of the analyte concentration may include transforming the signal using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein the values of one or more Michaelis-Menten parameters have been adjusted for temperature and pH.
[0265] In some embodiments, for instance, a method of estimating an analyte concentration of a solution may include generating a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the solution, generating a signal indicative of a temperature of the solution, generating a signal indicative of a pH of the solution, and transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters has been substituted with a calibration equation functionally depending on a set of one or more temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of the temperature, and the signal indicative of the pH. One could refer to such an equation as a "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation since the Michaelis-Menten parameters have been explicitly substituted with equations depending on one or more other variables— temperature, pH level, and the temperature and pH calibration parameters. However, although such a "substituted" equation exhibits a more complicated analytic form, it nevertheless will still express the basic functional relationships of the modified Michaelis-Menten equation.
[0266] In some embodiments, the step of transforming the signal indicative of analyte concentration may utilize a "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation in which each of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters have been substituted with first, second, and third calibration equations (respectively), each of the equations depending on sets of first, second, and third temperature and pH calibration parameters (respectively), and each also depending on the signal indicative of temperature and the signal indicative of pH.
[0267] In certain embodiments, the first calibration equation is the product of a first pH-independent polynomial in the signal indicative of temperature and a first temperature- independent polynomial in the signal indicative of pH. Similarly, in certain embodiments, the second calibration equation is the product of a second pH-independent polynomial in the signal indicative of temperature and a second temperature-independent polynomial in the signal indicative of pH; and the third calibration equation is the product of a third pH-independent polynomial in the signal indicative of temperature and a third temperature-independent function of the signal indicative of pH. In certain such embodiments, one or more of the first, second, and third pH-independent polynomials are linear equations in the signal indicative of temperature, and one or more of the first and second temperature-independent polynomials are linear equations in the signal indicative of pH, while the third temperature-independent function is a fraction wherein the numerator is equal to an exponential function of a function linear in the inverse of the signal indicative of pH, and the denominator is equal to an exponential function of the same function linear in the inverse of the signal indicative of pH evaluated at pH 7.4.
[0268] Note, that in many if not all of the methods described herein, transforming the signal indicative of analyte concentration using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis- Menten equation may utilize a look-up table. In some circumstances, function evaluation by use of a look-up table may be more computationally efficient than direct application of the same function as it is written. To illustrate, a function mapping a single input variable to a single output variable, e.g. y =fix), may be evaluated via a look-up table. In this simple case, the lookup table consists of a set of discrete matching input and output values, e.g. (x, y) pairs. Evaluating the function fix) or computing the output value j which corresponds to a given input value x, may be accomplished by looking up the input value x in the look-up table, and choosing the output value y in the table which corresponds to it. If the exact input value does not exist in the look-up table, the corresponding output value may be determined by interpolating from the output values in the table whose corresponding input values are similar to the original input value. Such methodology may be more efficient than evaluating a function, when looking up values in the look-up table and interpolating between values when necessary is quicker than applying the function as written to a given input value. However, use of a look-up table should be understood to simply be a potentially efficient way to approximate the application of a function in analytic form. Accordingly, when transformations using equations are described herein, it should be understood that such described transformations encompass the direct application of the equations as well as the use of a look-up table to approximate such transformations. More specifically, it is to be understood that reference herein to the transformation of one or more signals using an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis- Menten equation does encompass transformations utilizing a look-up table.
[0269] Thus, as described above, the calibration equations substituted into the modified Michaelis-Menten equation for the Michaelis-Menten parameters may take a variety of functional forms and each may have varying numbers of temperature and pH calibration parameters. Obviously, more complicated equations may have a greater numbers of temperature and pH calibration parameters. In any event, depending on the embodiment, various temperature and pH calibration methods may be used to determine the values of the first, second, and third sets of the one or more temperature and pH calibration parameters. In certain such embodiments, each set of temperature and pH calibration parameters may be determined by fitting the "substituted" modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a plurality of signals, the plurality of signals indicative of analyte concentration in a plurality of solutions having differing analyte concentrations, at a plurality of temperatures, and at a plurality of pH levels. Once values of the various temperature and pH calibration parameters are determined, temperature and pH corrected estimates of analyte concentrations may be generated from signals indicative of analyte concentration, temperature, and pH.
[0270] While a number of preferred embodiments of the invention and variations thereof have been described in detail, other modifications and methods of using and medical applications for the same will be apparent to those of skill in the art. Accordingly, it should be understood that various applications, modifications, and substitutions may be made of equivalents without departing from the spirit of the invention or the scope of the claims.

Claims

WHAT IS CLAIMED IS:
1. A method of estimating an analyte concentration in a physiologic fluid, comprising:
contacting an analyte sensing element with the fluid, wherein the analyte sensing element is configured to generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration in the fluid;
detecting the signal indicative of the analyte concentration;
contacting a temperature sensing element with the fluid, wherein the temperature sensing element is configured to generate a signal indicative of a temperature of the fluid; detecting the signal indicative of the temperature of the fluid; and transforming the detected signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing a modified Michaelis-Menten equation comprising Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data comprising:
temperature calibration data; and
the detected signal indicative of temperature.
2. The method of Claim 1, wherein both the analyte sensing element and the temperature sensing element are incorporated within a single sensor.
3. The method of Claim 1, wherein the temperature calibration data is generated by a temperature calibration method comprising:
providing at least three solutions of differing known analyte concentrations;
providing a first test analyte sensing element;
generating a first set of at least three signals using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of the at least three solutions at a first temperature;
generating a second set of at least three signals using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of the at least three solutions at a second temperature.
4. The method of Claim 3, wherein the temperature calibration method further comprises: determining values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a first fit dataset comprising the first set of at least three signals;
determining values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a second fit dataset comprising the second set of at least three signals;
selecting an equation relating the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters to temperature, the equation depending on a first set, second set, and third set of temperature calibration parameters respectively;
determining a value for each calibration parameter of the first, second, and third set of calibration parameters based on the value of the first, second, and third Michaelis- Menten parameters respectively at the first temperature; and
determining a value for each calibration parameter of the first, second, and third set of calibration parameters based on the value of the first, second, and third Michaelis- Menten parameters respectively at the second temperature.
5. The method of Claim 4, wherein:
for the step of selecting an equation, equations linear in temperature are selected to relate the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters to temperature; and each of the first, second, and third sets of temperature calibration parameters comprise a slope and an intercept relating temperature to the value of either the first, second, or third Michaelis-Menten parameter.
6. The method of Claim 4, wherein the temperature calibration method further comprises:
providing a second test analyte sensing element;
generating a third set of at least three signals using the second test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of the at least three solutions at the first temperature; generating a fourth set of at least three signals using the test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of the at least three solutions at the second temperature.
7. The method of Claim 6, wherein generating values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature by an algorithm further comprises:
fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a third fit dataset comprising the third set of at least three signals;
averaging the results of fitting the third fit dataset with the results of fitting the first fit dataset; and
determining each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature by
fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a fourth fit dataset comprising the fourth set of at least three signals; and
averaging the results of fitting the fourth fit dataset with the results of fitting the second fit dataset.
8. The method of Claim 1, wherein transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation comprises at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters substituted with a calibration equation that depends on a set of one or more temperature calibration parameters and the signal indicative of the temperature.
9. The method of Claim 8, wherein transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizes an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein:
the first Michaelis-Menten parameter has been substituted with a first calibration equation functionally depending on a first set of one or more temperature calibration parameters and the signal indicative of temperature;
the second Michaelis-Menten parameter has been substituted with a second calibration equation functionally depending on a second set of one or more temperature calibration parameters and the signal indicative of temperature; and
the third Michaelis-Menten parameter has been substituted with a third calibration equation functionally depending on a third set of one or more temperature calibration parameters and the signal indicative of temperature.
10. A method of estimating an analyte concentration in a physiologic fluid, comprising:
contacting an analyte sensing element with the fluid, wherein the analyte sensing element is configured to generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration in the fluid;
detecting the signal indicative of the analyte concentration;
contacting a pH sensing element with the fluid, wherein the pH sensing element is configured to generate a signal indicative of a pH of the fluid;
detecting the signal indicative of the pH of the fluid; and
transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing a modified Michaelis-Menten equation comprising Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data comprising:
pH calibration data; and
the detected signal indicative of pH.
11. The method of Claim 10, wherein both the analyte sensing element and the pH sensing element are incorporated within a single sensor.
12. The method of Claim 10, wherein the pH calibration data was generated by a pH calibration method comprising:
providing at least three solutions of differing known analyte concentrations;
providing a first test analyte sensing element;
selecting a first pH;
generating a first set of at least three signals using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of the at least three solutions at the first pH;
selecting a second pH; and
generating a second set of at least three signals using the first test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of the at least three solutions at the second pH.
13. The method of Claim 12, wherein the pH calibration method further comprises: determining values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a first fit dataset comprising the first set of at least three signals;
determining values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis- Menten equation to a second fit dataset comprising the second set of at least three signals; selecting an equation relating the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH, the equation depending on a first, second, and third set of pH calibration parameters respectively;
setting a value for each calibration parameter of the first, second, and third set of calibration parameters based on the value of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters respectively at the first pH and the value of the first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameters respectively at the second pH.
14. The method of Claim 13, wherein:
a first equation linear in pH is selected to relate the first Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH;
a second equation linear in pH is selected to relate the second Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH; and
an equation is selected to relate the third Michaelis-Menten parameter to pH which comprises a fraction wherein the numerator is equal to an exponential function of an equation linear in the inverse of pH, and the denominator is equal to an exponential function of the same linear function in the inverse of pH evaluated at fixed pH.
15. The method of Claim 13, wherein the pH calibration method further comprises: providing a second test analyte sensing element;
generating a third set of at least three signals using the second test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of the at least three solutions at the first pH;
generating a fourth set of at least three signals using the test analyte sensing element, each signal indicative of the concentration of analyte in a different solution of the at least three solutions at the second pH.
16. The method of Claim 15, wherein determining values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH by an algorithm further comprises:
fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a third fit dataset comprising the third set of at least three signals; and
averaging the results of fitting the third fit dataset with the results of fitting the first fit dataset; and
wherein generating values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH by
fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to a fourth fit dataset comprising the fourth set of at least three signals; and
averaging the results of fitting the fourth fit dataset with the results of fitting the second fit dataset.
17. The method of Claim 10, wherein transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation comprises at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters substituted with a calibration equation that depends on a set of one or more pH calibration parameters and the signal indicative ofpH.
18. The method of Claim 17, wherein the step of transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizes an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein:
the first Michaelis-Menten parameter has been substituted with a first calibration equation functionally depending on a first set of one or more pH calibration parameters and the signal indicative of pH;
the second Michaelis-Menten parameter has been substituted with a second calibration equation functionally depending on a second set of one or more pH calibration parameters and the signal indicative of pH; and
the third Michaelis-Menten parameter has been substituted with a third calibration equation functionally depending on a third set of one or more pH calibration parameters and the signal indicative of pH.
19. A method of estimating an analyte concentration in a physiologic fluid comprising: contacting an analyte sensor with the fluid, wherein the analyte sensor is configured to generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration;
detecting the signal indicative of the analyte concentration;
contacting a temperature sensing element configured to generate a signal indicative of a temperature;
detecting the signal indicative of the temperature;
contacting a pH sensing element configured to generate a signal indicative of a pH;
detecting the signal indicative of the pH; and
transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based on data comprising:
temperature and pH calibration data;
the detected signal indicative of temperature; and
the detected signal indicative of pH.
20. The method of Claim 19, wherein the analyte sensing element, the temperature sensing element and the pH sensing element are incorporated within a single sensor.
21. The method of Claim 19, wherein the signal indicative of the analyte concentration, the signal indicative of the temperature, and the signal indicative of the pH are each generated from a set of at least three signals each of which is indicative of the temperature, the pH, and the analyte concentration.
22. The method of Claim 19, wherein the temperature and pH calibration parameters are determined by a calibration method, the calibration method comprising:
selecting a first test analyte sensing element;
selecting three differing concentrations of analyte;
selecting a first temperature and a second temperature, the second differing from the first;
selecting a first pH and a second pH, the second differing from the first;
computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the first temperature, the at least three signals generated using the first test analyte sensing element;
computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second temperature by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the second temperature, the at least three signals generated using the first test analyte sensing element;
computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first pH by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis-Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the first pH, the at least three signals generated using the first test analyte sensing element;
computing values of each of a first, second, and third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the second pH by an algorithm comprising fitting a modified Michaelis- Menten equation to at least three signals indicative of the three differing concentrations of analyte in solution at the second pH, the at least three signals generated using the first test analyte sensing element;
selecting a first calibration equation relating the first Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH, the equation depending on a first set of the temperature and pH calibration parameters, and setting a value for each parameter based on the values of the first Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature, the second temperature, the first pH, and the second pH;
selecting a second calibration equation relating the second Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH, the equation depending on a second set of the temperature and pH calibration parameters, and setting a value for each parameter based on the values of the second Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature, the second temperature, the first pH, and the second pH; and
selecting a third calibration equation relating the third Michaelis-Menten parameter to temperature and pH, the equation depending on a third set of the temperature and pH calibration parameters, and setting a value for each parameter based on the values of the third Michaelis-Menten parameter at the first temperature, the second temperature, the first pH, and the second pH.
23. The method of Claim 22, wherein:
the first calibration equation is the product of a first pH-independent function and a first temperature-independent function;
the second calibration equation is the product of a second pH-independent function and a second temperature-independent function; and
the third calibration equation is the product of a third pH-independent function and a third temperature-independent function.
24. The method of Claim 23, wherein:
the first, second, and third pH-independent functions are linear in temperature; the first, and second temperature-independent functions are linear in pH; and the third temperature-independent function is a fraction wherein the numerator is equal to an exponential function of a function linear in the inverse of pH, and the denominator is equal to an exponential function of the same function linear in the inverse of pH evaluated at fixed pH.
25. The method of Claim 24, wherein transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation comprises at least one of the Michaelis-Menten parameters substituted with a calibration equation functionally that depends on a set of one or more temperature calibration parameters, pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of the temperature, and the signal indicative of the pH.
26. The method of Claim 25, wherein the step of transforming the signal indicative of the analyte concentration utilizes an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation wherein:
the first Michaelis-Menten parameter has been substituted with a first calibration equation functionally depending on a first set of temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of the temperature, and the signal indicative of the pH; the second Michaelis-Menten parameter has been substituted with a second calibration equation functionally depending on a second set of temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of temperature, and the signal indicative of pH; and
the third Michaelis-Menten parameter has been substituted with a third calibration equation functionally depending on a third set of temperature and pH calibration parameters, the signal indicative of temperature, and the signal indicative of pH.
27. A measurement device for estimating an analyte concentration comprising:
an analyte sensing element configured to generate a first signal indicative of the analyte concentration;
a temperature sensing element configured to generate a second signal indicative of a temperature; and
a receiving and processing unit configured to transform the first signal utilizing a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data comprising:
temperature calibration data; and
the second signal.
28. A measurement device for estimating an analyte concentration comprising:
an analyte sensor configured to generate a first signal indicative of the analyte concentration;
a pH sensor configured to generate a second signal, the second signal indicative of a pH; and
a receiving and processing unit configured to transform the first signal utilizing a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis-Menten parameters, wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data comprising:
pH calibration data; and
the second signal.
29. The measurement device of Claim 28, further comprising:
a temperature sensor configured to generate a third signal indicative of a temperature of the sample;
wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data further comprising:
temperature data; and the third signal.
30. The measurement device of any of Claims 28-29, wherein the analyte sensor comprises:
at least one light source configured to generate light;
an indicator system comprising:
at least one type of fluorophore which emits a fluorescence having an intensity in response to light from the at least one light source; and at least one type of binding moiety capable of binding the analyte, the at least one type of binding moiety operably coupled to the at least one type of fluorophore, such that when the sample contacts the at least one type of binding moiety the intensity is indicative of the concentration of the analyte; and at least one detector configured to detect the intensity and generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample in response to the intensity.
31. A measurement device for estimating an analyte concentration of a sample, the measurement device comprising:
an analyte and pH sensor configured to generate:
a first signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and a pH of the sample; and
a second signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and the pH of the sample; and
a receiving and processing unit configured to transform a third signal utilizing an equation of the form of a modified Michaelis-Menten equation depending on Michaelis- Menten parameters, wherein the third signal is indicative of the analyte concentration and is generated based upon data comprising the first signal and the second signal, and wherein values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data comprising:
pH calibration data; and
a fourth signal, the fourth signal indicative of the pH and generated based upon data comprising the first signal and the second signal.
32. The measurement device of Claim 31 , further comprising:
a temperature sensor configured to generate a fifth signal, the fifth signal indicative of a temperature of the sample; wherein the values of the Michaelis-Menten parameters are set based upon data further comprising temperature data and the fifth signal.
33. The measurement device of any of Claims 31 or 32, wherein the analyte and pH sensor comprises:
at least one light source configured to generate light;
an indicator system comprising:
at least one type of fluorophore which emits a fluorescence having an intensity in response to light from the at least one light source; and at least one type of binding moiety capable of binding the analyte, the at least one type of binding moiety operably coupled to the at least one type of fluorophore, such that when the sample contacts the at least one type of binding moiety the intensity is indicative of the concentration of the analyte and the pH; and
at least one detector configured to detect the intensity and generate a signal indicative of the analyte concentration of the sample and the pH of the sample in response to the intensity.
34. The measurement device of any of Claims 30 or 33, wherein the indicator system further comprises an immobilizing medium configured to prevent some of the fluorophores and/or some of the binding moieties from freely diffusing through the sample.
35. The measurement device of any of Claims 27, 29, or 34, further comprising a sensor probe wherein the temperature sensor and the analyte sensor are co-located within a distal tip of the sensor probe.
PCT/US2011/028222 2010-03-11 2011-03-11 Measurement devices and methods for measuring analyte concentration incorporating temperature and ph correction WO2011113020A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
EP11754226.6A EP2545373B1 (en) 2010-03-11 2011-03-11 Measuring analyte concentration incorporating temperature and ph correction

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US31306610P 2010-03-11 2010-03-11
US61/313,066 2010-03-11

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2011113020A1 true WO2011113020A1 (en) 2011-09-15

Family

ID=44560611

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2011/028222 WO2011113020A1 (en) 2010-03-11 2011-03-11 Measurement devices and methods for measuring analyte concentration incorporating temperature and ph correction

Country Status (3)

Country Link
US (2) US8473222B2 (en)
EP (1) EP2545373B1 (en)
WO (1) WO2011113020A1 (en)

Cited By (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2013190281A1 (en) 2012-06-21 2013-12-27 Lightship Medical Limited Glucose sensor
US8940542B2 (en) 2012-03-15 2015-01-27 Lighthouse Medical Limited Sensor
US8979790B2 (en) 2007-11-21 2015-03-17 Medtronic Minimed, Inc. Use of an equilibrium sensor to monitor glucose concentration
WO2017124126A1 (en) * 2016-01-22 2017-07-27 Smaxtec Animal Care Gmbh Probe unit for measuring at least one state variable of the organism of a livestock animal, and method for starting up same

Families Citing this family (32)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JP2010517693A (en) 2007-02-06 2010-05-27 グルメトリクス, インコーポレイテッド Optical system and method for ratiometric measurement of blood glucose concentration
US8972196B2 (en) * 2007-02-06 2015-03-03 Medtronic Minimed, Inc. Algorithms for calibrating an analyte sensor
WO2008141241A1 (en) 2007-05-10 2008-11-20 Glumetrics, Inc. Equilibrium non-consuming fluorescence sensor for real time intravascular glucose measurement
JP2013506503A (en) 2009-09-30 2013-02-28 グルメトリクス, インコーポレイテッド Sensor with antithrombogenic coating
US8467843B2 (en) 2009-11-04 2013-06-18 Glumetrics, Inc. Optical sensor configuration for ratiometric correction of blood glucose measurement
JP2012093190A (en) * 2010-10-26 2012-05-17 Olympus Corp Correction method of fluorescence sensor and fluorescence sensor
US9051598B2 (en) * 2011-05-02 2015-06-09 The Hong Kong University Of Science And Technology Specific detection of D-glucose by a tetraphenylethene-base fluorescent sensor
JP5542888B2 (en) * 2011-10-17 2014-07-09 アークレイ株式会社 Protein concentration evaluation method, analysis tool, and analyzer
GB201119352D0 (en) 2011-11-09 2011-12-21 Advanced Sensors Ltd Apparatus and method for determining the amounts of two or more substances present in a liquid
US10881339B2 (en) * 2012-06-29 2021-01-05 Dexcom, Inc. Use of sensor redundancy to detect sensor failures
US10598627B2 (en) 2012-06-29 2020-03-24 Dexcom, Inc. Devices, systems, and methods to compensate for effects of temperature on implantable sensors
WO2014074621A1 (en) 2012-11-07 2014-05-15 Glumetrics, Inc. Dry insertion and one-point in vivo calibration of an optical analyte sensor
JP6412883B2 (en) * 2013-01-22 2018-10-24 ベクトン・ディキンソン・アンド・カンパニーBecton, Dickinson And Company Miniaturized optical coupler for fluorescence detection
GB2512842A (en) 2013-04-08 2014-10-15 Sphere Medical Ltd Sensor calibration method and apparatus
KR101847748B1 (en) 2013-08-22 2018-04-10 소니 주식회사 Water soluble fluorescent or colored dyes and methods for their use
US9617578B2 (en) 2013-12-06 2017-04-11 Verily Life Sciences Llc Sensor membrane with low temperature coefficient
DE102014106489A1 (en) * 2014-05-08 2015-11-12 B. Braun Avitum Ag Device and device control method for the quantitative determination of the concentration of selected substances filtered out of a patient's body in a liquid
KR20170120677A (en) 2015-02-26 2017-10-31 소니 주식회사 Water-soluble fluorescent or colored dyes including conjugated groups
KR102525252B1 (en) 2016-04-01 2023-04-26 소니그룹주식회사 Very bright dimeric or polymeric dyes with rigid space groups
WO2017197014A2 (en) 2016-05-10 2017-11-16 Sony Corporation Compositions comprising a polymeric dye and a cyclodextrin and uses thereof
WO2017196954A1 (en) 2016-05-10 2017-11-16 Sony Corporation Ultra bright polymeric dyes with peptide backbones
CN109071961B (en) 2016-05-11 2021-04-27 索尼公司 Ultra-bright dimeric or polymeric dyes
JP7068191B2 (en) 2016-06-06 2022-05-16 ソニーグループ株式会社 Ionic polymer containing fluorescent or colored reporter groups
CN106324059B (en) * 2016-08-24 2018-08-21 东北师范大学 A kind of preparation method of glucose sensor electrode without enzyme material
CN106557655A (en) * 2016-11-17 2017-04-05 包磊 Method and apparatus is recommended in a kind of analysis based on User Status
CN108937955A (en) * 2017-05-23 2018-12-07 广州贝塔铁克医疗生物科技有限公司 The adaptive wearable blood glucose bearing calibration of personalization and its means for correcting based on artificial intelligence
WO2019099789A1 (en) 2017-11-16 2019-05-23 Sony Corporation Programmable polymeric drugs
JP2021520423A (en) 2018-03-19 2021-08-19 ソニーグループ株式会社 Use of divalent metals to enhance fluorescent signals
WO2019182766A1 (en) 2018-03-21 2019-09-26 Sony Corporation Polymeric tandem dyes with linker groups
DE102018126183B4 (en) * 2018-10-22 2020-08-06 Fraunhofer-Gesellschaft zur Förderung der angewandten Forschung e.V. Method for determining the concentration of a fluorescent and / or fluorescence-labeled analyte and calibration method for preparing this determination
CN109682968B (en) * 2018-11-08 2022-03-11 上海艾瑞德生物科技有限公司 Temperature correction method for quantitative detection test signal of fluorescence immunoassay strip
WO2021062176A2 (en) 2019-09-26 2021-04-01 Sony Corporation Polymeric tandem dyes with linker groups

Citations (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5810985A (en) * 1992-09-14 1998-09-22 Purdue Research Foundation Electrophoretically mediated chemical analysis
US6602702B1 (en) * 1999-07-16 2003-08-05 The University Of Texas System Detection system based on an analyte reactive particle
US20050130249A1 (en) * 2000-05-16 2005-06-16 Cygnus, Inc. Methods for measuring analyte in a subject and/or compensating for incomplete reaction involving detection of the analyte
US20060189863A1 (en) * 1998-04-30 2006-08-24 Abbott Diabetes Care, Inc. Analyte monitoring device and methods of use

Family Cites Families (60)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4810655A (en) * 1985-07-03 1989-03-07 Abbott Laboratories Method for measuring oxygen concentration
DE3784853T2 (en) * 1986-11-28 1993-06-24 Takeda Chemical Industries Ltd METHOD FOR PRODUCING CARBONIC ACID ESTERS.
AT390517B (en) * 1988-08-04 1990-05-25 Avl Verbrennungskraft Messtech OPTICAL SENSOR AND METHOD FOR THE PRODUCTION THEREOF
US5512246A (en) * 1989-09-21 1996-04-30 Anthony P. Russell Method and means for detecting polyhydroxyl compounds
US5137833A (en) * 1989-09-21 1992-08-11 Russell Anthony P Method for detecting polyhydroxyl compounds
US5137033A (en) * 1991-07-15 1992-08-11 Norton John L Patient monitoring device
EP0891807A3 (en) * 1993-06-30 1999-05-12 Diametrics Medical Ltd. Biphasic material
GB2284809B (en) * 1993-11-07 1998-04-29 Japan Res Dev Corp A fluorescent phenylboronic acid suitable for use in the detection of saccharides
JP2799837B2 (en) * 1995-03-03 1998-09-21 科学技術振興事業団 Boronic acid compounds having a binaphthyl group
US6766183B2 (en) * 1995-11-22 2004-07-20 Medtronic Minimed, Inc. Long wave fluorophore sensor compounds and other fluorescent sensor compounds in polymers
WO1997019188A1 (en) * 1995-11-22 1997-05-29 Minimed, Inc. Detection of biological molecules using chemical amplification and optical sensors
US6002954A (en) * 1995-11-22 1999-12-14 The Regents Of The University Of California Detection of biological molecules using boronate-based chemical amplification and optical sensors
DE19624753A1 (en) 1996-06-21 1998-01-02 Teves Gmbh Alfred Hydraulic motor vehicle brake system with wheel slip control
US7899511B2 (en) * 2004-07-13 2011-03-01 Dexcom, Inc. Low oxygen in vivo analyte sensor
US6579690B1 (en) * 1997-12-05 2003-06-17 Therasense, Inc. Blood analyte monitoring through subcutaneous measurement
US20010008766A1 (en) * 1998-03-17 2001-07-19 Sylvia Daunert Quantitative binding assays using green fluorescent protein as a label
DE69941085D1 (en) * 1998-07-17 2009-08-20 Univ Maryland MANIPULATED PROTEINS FOR ANALYSIS PROOF
US6304766B1 (en) * 1998-08-26 2001-10-16 Sensors For Medicine And Science Optical-based sensing devices, especially for in-situ sensing in humans
WO2002012251A1 (en) * 2000-08-04 2002-02-14 Sensors For Medicine And Science, Inc. Detection of analytes in aqueous environments
US6227927B1 (en) * 2000-08-09 2001-05-08 Frank T. Smith Sound producing device
US7470420B2 (en) * 2000-12-05 2008-12-30 The Regents Of The University Of California Optical determination of glucose utilizing boronic acid adducts
US6627177B2 (en) * 2000-12-05 2003-09-30 The Regents Of The University Of California Polyhydroxyl-substituted organic molecule sensing optical in vivo method utilizing a boronic acid adduct and the device thereof
US6653141B2 (en) * 2000-12-05 2003-11-25 The Regents Of The University Of California Polyhydroxyl-substituted organic molecule sensing method and device
US6800451B2 (en) * 2001-01-05 2004-10-05 Sensors For Medicine And Science, Inc. Detection of glucose in solutions also containing an alpha-hydroxy acid or a beta-diketone
US6432695B1 (en) * 2001-02-16 2002-08-13 Institute Of Microelectronics Miniaturized thermal cycler
ATE509120T1 (en) * 2001-09-18 2011-05-15 Carnegie Inst Of Washington FUSION PROTEINS FOR DETECTING ANALYTES
US20030232383A1 (en) * 2001-11-02 2003-12-18 Sylvia Daunert Novel reagentless sensing system for measuring carbohydrates based on the galactose/glucose binding protein
AU2002360487A1 (en) * 2001-12-04 2003-06-17 Ashim K. Mitra Acyclovir-peptide analogs
US7064103B2 (en) * 2002-01-04 2006-06-20 Becton, Dickinson And Company Binding protein as biosensors
US6855556B2 (en) * 2002-01-04 2005-02-15 Becton, Dickinson And Company Binding protein as biosensors
US20050053954A1 (en) * 2002-11-01 2005-03-10 Brennan John D. Multicomponent protein microarrays
GB0229263D0 (en) 2002-12-16 2003-01-22 Diametrics Medical Ltd Improvements in or relating to sensor devices for monitoring the condition of a human or animal patient
US7390462B2 (en) * 2002-12-17 2008-06-24 The University Of Maryland Baltimore County Ratiometric fluorescent pH sensor for non-invasive monitoring
EP1623227A4 (en) * 2003-05-09 2009-03-04 Univ Maryland Proteins, sensors, and methods of characterizing analytes using the same
US8060173B2 (en) * 2003-08-01 2011-11-15 Dexcom, Inc. System and methods for processing analyte sensor data
US7496392B2 (en) * 2003-11-26 2009-02-24 Becton, Dickinson And Company Fiber optic device for sensing analytes
US8338138B2 (en) * 2004-01-28 2012-12-25 The John Hopkins University Methods for making and using molecular switches involving circular permutation
US7345160B2 (en) * 2004-03-29 2008-03-18 University Of Kentucky Research Foundation Aequorin and obelin mutants with differing wavelengths and bioluminescence
WO2005119223A1 (en) * 2004-04-14 2005-12-15 Bioprocessors Corp. Compositions of matter useful as ph indicators and related methods
US20070207498A1 (en) * 2005-02-24 2007-09-06 Lifescan, Inc. Design and construction of dimeric concanavalin a mutants
US20090048430A1 (en) * 2005-11-02 2009-02-19 Duke University Site specific protein modification
EP2054476B9 (en) * 2006-07-25 2012-03-14 Glumetrics, Inc. Flourescent dyes for use in glucose sensing
EP2093425B1 (en) 2006-12-15 2016-11-09 Kawasaki Jukogyo Kabushiki Kaisha Swash plate type piston pump motor
US8088097B2 (en) * 2007-11-21 2012-01-03 Glumetrics, Inc. Use of an equilibrium intravascular sensor to achieve tight glycemic control
EP2122334B1 (en) * 2007-02-06 2018-01-24 Medtronic Minimed, Inc. Method for polymerizing a monomer solution within a cavity to generate a smooth polymer surface
US7751863B2 (en) * 2007-02-06 2010-07-06 Glumetrics, Inc. Optical determination of ph and glucose
US8972196B2 (en) * 2007-02-06 2015-03-03 Medtronic Minimed, Inc. Algorithms for calibrating an analyte sensor
US7824918B2 (en) * 2007-08-06 2010-11-02 Glumetrics, Inc. HPTS-Mono and BIS Cys-Ma polymerizable fluorescent dyes for use in analyte sensors
JP2010517693A (en) * 2007-02-06 2010-05-27 グルメトリクス, インコーポレイテッド Optical system and method for ratiometric measurement of blood glucose concentration
CA2684511A1 (en) * 2007-05-01 2008-11-13 Glumetrics, Inc. Pyridinium boronic acid quenchers for use in analyte sensors
WO2008141243A2 (en) * 2007-05-10 2008-11-20 Glumetrics, Inc. Device and methods for calibrating analyte sensors
WO2008141241A1 (en) * 2007-05-10 2008-11-20 Glumetrics, Inc. Equilibrium non-consuming fluorescence sensor for real time intravascular glucose measurement
JP5453248B2 (en) * 2007-05-22 2014-03-26 ベクトン・ディキンソン・アンド・カンパニー Dyes with a ratiometric fluorescence response to detect metabolites
JP5675350B2 (en) * 2007-07-11 2015-02-25 メドトロニック ミニメド インコーポレイテッド Polyviologen compound, method for synthesizing the compound, glucose sensor, and composition for measuring glucose
US20110229415A1 (en) 2007-08-06 2011-09-22 Sylvia Daunert Semi-synthetic antibodies as recognition elements
US8465981B2 (en) 2007-08-06 2013-06-18 University Of Kentucky Research Foundation Polypeptides, systems, and methods useful for detecting glucose
WO2009036070A1 (en) 2007-09-10 2009-03-19 University Of Kentucky Research Foundation Spores for the stabilization and on-site application of bacterial whole-cell biosensing systems
WO2009034158A2 (en) * 2007-09-12 2009-03-19 Probiodrug Ag Transgenic mice
US9023661B2 (en) * 2007-10-18 2015-05-05 Becton, Dickinson And Company Visual glucose sensor and methods of use thereof
WO2009129186A2 (en) * 2008-04-17 2009-10-22 Glumetrics, Inc. Sensor for percutaneous intravascular deployment without an indwelling cannula

Patent Citations (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5810985A (en) * 1992-09-14 1998-09-22 Purdue Research Foundation Electrophoretically mediated chemical analysis
US20060189863A1 (en) * 1998-04-30 2006-08-24 Abbott Diabetes Care, Inc. Analyte monitoring device and methods of use
US6602702B1 (en) * 1999-07-16 2003-08-05 The University Of Texas System Detection system based on an analyte reactive particle
US20050130249A1 (en) * 2000-05-16 2005-06-16 Cygnus, Inc. Methods for measuring analyte in a subject and/or compensating for incomplete reaction involving detection of the analyte

Non-Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
See also references of EP2545373A4 *

Cited By (7)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US8979790B2 (en) 2007-11-21 2015-03-17 Medtronic Minimed, Inc. Use of an equilibrium sensor to monitor glucose concentration
US8940542B2 (en) 2012-03-15 2015-01-27 Lighthouse Medical Limited Sensor
US9476886B2 (en) 2012-03-15 2016-10-25 Lightship Medical Limited Sensor
US9797909B2 (en) 2012-03-15 2017-10-24 Lightship Medical Limited Sensor
WO2013190281A1 (en) 2012-06-21 2013-12-27 Lightship Medical Limited Glucose sensor
US11255860B2 (en) 2012-06-21 2022-02-22 Baxter International Inc. Glucose sensor
WO2017124126A1 (en) * 2016-01-22 2017-07-27 Smaxtec Animal Care Gmbh Probe unit for measuring at least one state variable of the organism of a livestock animal, and method for starting up same

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
EP2545373B1 (en) 2022-08-24
US8473222B2 (en) 2013-06-25
US20130287631A1 (en) 2013-10-31
US20110224516A1 (en) 2011-09-15
EP2545373A1 (en) 2013-01-16
EP2545373A4 (en) 2017-08-02

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
EP2545373B1 (en) Measuring analyte concentration incorporating temperature and ph correction
US7751863B2 (en) Optical determination of ph and glucose
US8700115B2 (en) Optical sensor configuration for ratiometric correction of glucose measurement
US9693720B2 (en) Equilibrium non-consuming fluorescence sensor for real time intravascular glucose measurement
EP2989975B1 (en) Optical systems and methods for rationmetric measurement of blood glucose concentration
JP6534616B2 (en) Dry insertion and one point in vivo calibration of optical analyte sensor
EP2751577B1 (en) A method of manufacturing a sterilized optical analyte sensor

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 11754226

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2011754226

Country of ref document: EP